1 /* ELF executable support for BFD.
3 Copyright (C) 1993-2018 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 This file is part of BFD, the Binary File Descriptor library.
7 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
12 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
19 Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street - Fifth Floor, Boston,
20 MA 02110-1301, USA. */
27 BFD support for ELF formats is being worked on.
28 Currently, the best supported back ends are for sparc and i386
29 (running svr4 or Solaris 2).
31 Documentation of the internals of the support code still needs
32 to be written. The code is changing quickly enough that we
33 haven't bothered yet. */
35 /* For sparc64-cross-sparc32. */
43 #include "libiberty.h"
44 #include "safe-ctype.h"
45 #include "elf-linux-core.h"
51 static int elf_sort_sections (const void *, const void *);
52 static bfd_boolean assign_file_positions_except_relocs (bfd *, struct bfd_link_info *);
53 static bfd_boolean prep_headers (bfd *);
54 static bfd_boolean swap_out_syms (bfd *, struct elf_strtab_hash **, int) ;
55 static bfd_boolean elf_read_notes (bfd *, file_ptr, bfd_size_type,
57 static bfd_boolean elf_parse_notes (bfd *abfd, char *buf, size_t size,
58 file_ptr offset, size_t align);
60 /* Swap version information in and out. The version information is
61 currently size independent. If that ever changes, this code will
62 need to move into elfcode.h. */
64 /* Swap in a Verdef structure. */
67 _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_in (bfd *abfd,
68 const Elf_External_Verdef *src,
69 Elf_Internal_Verdef *dst)
71 dst->vd_version = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_version);
72 dst->vd_flags = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_flags);
73 dst->vd_ndx = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_ndx);
74 dst->vd_cnt = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_cnt);
75 dst->vd_hash = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vd_hash);
76 dst->vd_aux = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vd_aux);
77 dst->vd_next = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vd_next);
80 /* Swap out a Verdef structure. */
83 _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_out (bfd *abfd,
84 const Elf_Internal_Verdef *src,
85 Elf_External_Verdef *dst)
87 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_version, dst->vd_version);
88 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_flags, dst->vd_flags);
89 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_ndx, dst->vd_ndx);
90 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_cnt, dst->vd_cnt);
91 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vd_hash, dst->vd_hash);
92 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vd_aux, dst->vd_aux);
93 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vd_next, dst->vd_next);
96 /* Swap in a Verdaux structure. */
99 _bfd_elf_swap_verdaux_in (bfd *abfd,
100 const Elf_External_Verdaux *src,
101 Elf_Internal_Verdaux *dst)
103 dst->vda_name = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vda_name);
104 dst->vda_next = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vda_next);
107 /* Swap out a Verdaux structure. */
110 _bfd_elf_swap_verdaux_out (bfd *abfd,
111 const Elf_Internal_Verdaux *src,
112 Elf_External_Verdaux *dst)
114 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vda_name, dst->vda_name);
115 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vda_next, dst->vda_next);
118 /* Swap in a Verneed structure. */
121 _bfd_elf_swap_verneed_in (bfd *abfd,
122 const Elf_External_Verneed *src,
123 Elf_Internal_Verneed *dst)
125 dst->vn_version = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vn_version);
126 dst->vn_cnt = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vn_cnt);
127 dst->vn_file = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vn_file);
128 dst->vn_aux = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vn_aux);
129 dst->vn_next = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vn_next);
132 /* Swap out a Verneed structure. */
135 _bfd_elf_swap_verneed_out (bfd *abfd,
136 const Elf_Internal_Verneed *src,
137 Elf_External_Verneed *dst)
139 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vn_version, dst->vn_version);
140 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vn_cnt, dst->vn_cnt);
141 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vn_file, dst->vn_file);
142 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vn_aux, dst->vn_aux);
143 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vn_next, dst->vn_next);
146 /* Swap in a Vernaux structure. */
149 _bfd_elf_swap_vernaux_in (bfd *abfd,
150 const Elf_External_Vernaux *src,
151 Elf_Internal_Vernaux *dst)
153 dst->vna_hash = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vna_hash);
154 dst->vna_flags = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vna_flags);
155 dst->vna_other = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vna_other);
156 dst->vna_name = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vna_name);
157 dst->vna_next = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vna_next);
160 /* Swap out a Vernaux structure. */
163 _bfd_elf_swap_vernaux_out (bfd *abfd,
164 const Elf_Internal_Vernaux *src,
165 Elf_External_Vernaux *dst)
167 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vna_hash, dst->vna_hash);
168 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vna_flags, dst->vna_flags);
169 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vna_other, dst->vna_other);
170 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vna_name, dst->vna_name);
171 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vna_next, dst->vna_next);
174 /* Swap in a Versym structure. */
177 _bfd_elf_swap_versym_in (bfd *abfd,
178 const Elf_External_Versym *src,
179 Elf_Internal_Versym *dst)
181 dst->vs_vers = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vs_vers);
184 /* Swap out a Versym structure. */
187 _bfd_elf_swap_versym_out (bfd *abfd,
188 const Elf_Internal_Versym *src,
189 Elf_External_Versym *dst)
191 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vs_vers, dst->vs_vers);
194 /* Standard ELF hash function. Do not change this function; you will
195 cause invalid hash tables to be generated. */
198 bfd_elf_hash (const char *namearg)
200 const unsigned char *name = (const unsigned char *) namearg;
205 while ((ch = *name++) != '\0')
208 if ((g = (h & 0xf0000000)) != 0)
211 /* The ELF ABI says `h &= ~g', but this is equivalent in
212 this case and on some machines one insn instead of two. */
216 return h & 0xffffffff;
219 /* DT_GNU_HASH hash function. Do not change this function; you will
220 cause invalid hash tables to be generated. */
223 bfd_elf_gnu_hash (const char *namearg)
225 const unsigned char *name = (const unsigned char *) namearg;
226 unsigned long h = 5381;
229 while ((ch = *name++) != '\0')
230 h = (h << 5) + h + ch;
231 return h & 0xffffffff;
234 /* Create a tdata field OBJECT_SIZE bytes in length, zeroed out and with
235 the object_id field of an elf_obj_tdata field set to OBJECT_ID. */
237 bfd_elf_allocate_object (bfd *abfd,
239 enum elf_target_id object_id)
241 BFD_ASSERT (object_size >= sizeof (struct elf_obj_tdata));
242 abfd->tdata.any = bfd_zalloc (abfd, object_size);
243 if (abfd->tdata.any == NULL)
246 elf_object_id (abfd) = object_id;
247 if (abfd->direction != read_direction)
249 struct output_elf_obj_tdata *o = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof *o);
252 elf_tdata (abfd)->o = o;
253 elf_program_header_size (abfd) = (bfd_size_type) -1;
260 bfd_elf_make_object (bfd *abfd)
262 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
263 return bfd_elf_allocate_object (abfd, sizeof (struct elf_obj_tdata),
268 bfd_elf_mkcorefile (bfd *abfd)
270 /* I think this can be done just like an object file. */
271 if (!abfd->xvec->_bfd_set_format[(int) bfd_object] (abfd))
273 elf_tdata (abfd)->core = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (*elf_tdata (abfd)->core));
274 return elf_tdata (abfd)->core != NULL;
278 bfd_elf_get_str_section (bfd *abfd, unsigned int shindex)
280 Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrp;
281 bfd_byte *shstrtab = NULL;
283 bfd_size_type shstrtabsize;
285 i_shdrp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
287 || shindex >= elf_numsections (abfd)
288 || i_shdrp[shindex] == 0)
291 shstrtab = i_shdrp[shindex]->contents;
292 if (shstrtab == NULL)
294 /* No cached one, attempt to read, and cache what we read. */
295 offset = i_shdrp[shindex]->sh_offset;
296 shstrtabsize = i_shdrp[shindex]->sh_size;
298 /* Allocate and clear an extra byte at the end, to prevent crashes
299 in case the string table is not terminated. */
300 if (shstrtabsize + 1 <= 1
301 || shstrtabsize > bfd_get_file_size (abfd)
302 || bfd_seek (abfd, offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
303 || (shstrtab = (bfd_byte *) bfd_alloc (abfd, shstrtabsize + 1)) == NULL)
305 else if (bfd_bread (shstrtab, shstrtabsize, abfd) != shstrtabsize)
307 if (bfd_get_error () != bfd_error_system_call)
308 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_truncated);
309 bfd_release (abfd, shstrtab);
311 /* Once we've failed to read it, make sure we don't keep
312 trying. Otherwise, we'll keep allocating space for
313 the string table over and over. */
314 i_shdrp[shindex]->sh_size = 0;
317 shstrtab[shstrtabsize] = '\0';
318 i_shdrp[shindex]->contents = shstrtab;
320 return (char *) shstrtab;
324 bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (bfd *abfd,
325 unsigned int shindex,
326 unsigned int strindex)
328 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
333 if (elf_elfsections (abfd) == NULL || shindex >= elf_numsections (abfd))
336 hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex];
338 if (hdr->contents == NULL)
340 if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_STRTAB && hdr->sh_type < SHT_LOOS)
342 /* PR 17512: file: f057ec89. */
343 /* xgettext:c-format */
344 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: attempt to load strings from"
345 " a non-string section (number %d)"),
350 if (bfd_elf_get_str_section (abfd, shindex) == NULL)
354 if (strindex >= hdr->sh_size)
356 unsigned int shstrndx = elf_elfheader(abfd)->e_shstrndx;
358 /* xgettext:c-format */
359 (_("%pB: invalid string offset %u >= %" PRIu64 " for section `%s'"),
360 abfd, strindex, (uint64_t) hdr->sh_size,
361 (shindex == shstrndx && strindex == hdr->sh_name
363 : bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, shstrndx, hdr->sh_name)));
367 return ((char *) hdr->contents) + strindex;
370 /* Read and convert symbols to internal format.
371 SYMCOUNT specifies the number of symbols to read, starting from
372 symbol SYMOFFSET. If any of INTSYM_BUF, EXTSYM_BUF or EXTSHNDX_BUF
373 are non-NULL, they are used to store the internal symbols, external
374 symbols, and symbol section index extensions, respectively.
375 Returns a pointer to the internal symbol buffer (malloced if necessary)
376 or NULL if there were no symbols or some kind of problem. */
379 bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (bfd *ibfd,
380 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr,
383 Elf_Internal_Sym *intsym_buf,
385 Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *extshndx_buf)
387 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shndx_hdr;
389 const bfd_byte *esym;
390 Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *alloc_extshndx;
391 Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *shndx;
392 Elf_Internal_Sym *alloc_intsym;
393 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
394 Elf_Internal_Sym *isymend;
395 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
400 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
406 /* Normal syms might have section extension entries. */
408 if (elf_symtab_shndx_list (ibfd) != NULL)
410 elf_section_list * entry;
411 Elf_Internal_Shdr **sections = elf_elfsections (ibfd);
413 /* Find an index section that is linked to this symtab section. */
414 for (entry = elf_symtab_shndx_list (ibfd); entry != NULL; entry = entry->next)
417 if (entry->hdr.sh_link >= elf_numsections (ibfd))
420 if (sections[entry->hdr.sh_link] == symtab_hdr)
422 shndx_hdr = & entry->hdr;
427 if (shndx_hdr == NULL)
429 if (symtab_hdr == & elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd))
430 /* Not really accurate, but this was how the old code used to work. */
431 shndx_hdr = & elf_symtab_shndx_list (ibfd)->hdr;
432 /* Otherwise we do nothing. The assumption is that
433 the index table will not be needed. */
437 /* Read the symbols. */
439 alloc_extshndx = NULL;
441 bed = get_elf_backend_data (ibfd);
442 extsym_size = bed->s->sizeof_sym;
443 amt = (bfd_size_type) symcount * extsym_size;
444 pos = symtab_hdr->sh_offset + symoffset * extsym_size;
445 if (extsym_buf == NULL)
447 alloc_ext = bfd_malloc2 (symcount, extsym_size);
448 extsym_buf = alloc_ext;
450 if (extsym_buf == NULL
451 || bfd_seek (ibfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0
452 || bfd_bread (extsym_buf, amt, ibfd) != amt)
458 if (shndx_hdr == NULL || shndx_hdr->sh_size == 0)
462 amt = (bfd_size_type) symcount * sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
463 pos = shndx_hdr->sh_offset + symoffset * sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
464 if (extshndx_buf == NULL)
466 alloc_extshndx = (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *)
467 bfd_malloc2 (symcount, sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx));
468 extshndx_buf = alloc_extshndx;
470 if (extshndx_buf == NULL
471 || bfd_seek (ibfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0
472 || bfd_bread (extshndx_buf, amt, ibfd) != amt)
479 if (intsym_buf == NULL)
481 alloc_intsym = (Elf_Internal_Sym *)
482 bfd_malloc2 (symcount, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Sym));
483 intsym_buf = alloc_intsym;
484 if (intsym_buf == NULL)
488 /* Convert the symbols to internal form. */
489 isymend = intsym_buf + symcount;
490 for (esym = (const bfd_byte *) extsym_buf, isym = intsym_buf,
491 shndx = extshndx_buf;
493 esym += extsym_size, isym++, shndx = shndx != NULL ? shndx + 1 : NULL)
494 if (!(*bed->s->swap_symbol_in) (ibfd, esym, shndx, isym))
496 symoffset += (esym - (bfd_byte *) extsym_buf) / extsym_size;
497 /* xgettext:c-format */
498 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB symbol number %lu references"
499 " nonexistent SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX section"),
500 ibfd, (unsigned long) symoffset);
501 if (alloc_intsym != NULL)
508 if (alloc_ext != NULL)
510 if (alloc_extshndx != NULL)
511 free (alloc_extshndx);
516 /* Look up a symbol name. */
518 bfd_elf_sym_name (bfd *abfd,
519 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr,
520 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym,
524 unsigned int iname = isym->st_name;
525 unsigned int shindex = symtab_hdr->sh_link;
527 if (iname == 0 && ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_SECTION
528 /* Check for a bogus st_shndx to avoid crashing. */
529 && isym->st_shndx < elf_numsections (abfd))
531 iname = elf_elfsections (abfd)[isym->st_shndx]->sh_name;
532 shindex = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_shstrndx;
535 name = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, shindex, iname);
538 else if (sym_sec && *name == '\0')
539 name = bfd_section_name (abfd, sym_sec);
544 /* Elf_Internal_Shdr->contents is an array of these for SHT_GROUP
545 sections. The first element is the flags, the rest are section
548 typedef union elf_internal_group {
549 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr;
551 } Elf_Internal_Group;
553 /* Return the name of the group signature symbol. Why isn't the
554 signature just a string? */
557 group_signature (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Shdr *ghdr)
559 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
560 unsigned char esym[sizeof (Elf64_External_Sym)];
561 Elf_External_Sym_Shndx eshndx;
562 Elf_Internal_Sym isym;
564 /* First we need to ensure the symbol table is available. Make sure
565 that it is a symbol table section. */
566 if (ghdr->sh_link >= elf_numsections (abfd))
568 hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd) [ghdr->sh_link];
569 if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_SYMTAB
570 || ! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, ghdr->sh_link))
573 /* Go read the symbol. */
574 hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
575 if (bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (abfd, hdr, 1, ghdr->sh_info,
576 &isym, esym, &eshndx) == NULL)
579 return bfd_elf_sym_name (abfd, hdr, &isym, NULL);
582 /* Set next_in_group list pointer, and group name for NEWSECT. */
585 setup_group (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr, asection *newsect)
587 unsigned int num_group = elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group;
589 /* If num_group is zero, read in all SHT_GROUP sections. The count
590 is set to -1 if there are no SHT_GROUP sections. */
593 unsigned int i, shnum;
595 /* First count the number of groups. If we have a SHT_GROUP
596 section with just a flag word (ie. sh_size is 4), ignore it. */
597 shnum = elf_numsections (abfd);
600 #define IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER(shdr, minsize) \
601 ( (shdr)->sh_type == SHT_GROUP \
602 && (shdr)->sh_size >= minsize \
603 && (shdr)->sh_entsize == GRP_ENTRY_SIZE \
604 && ((shdr)->sh_size % GRP_ENTRY_SIZE) == 0)
606 for (i = 0; i < shnum; i++)
608 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
610 if (IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER (shdr, 2 * GRP_ENTRY_SIZE))
616 num_group = (unsigned) -1;
617 elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group = num_group;
618 elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr = NULL;
622 /* We keep a list of elf section headers for group sections,
623 so we can find them quickly. */
626 elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group = num_group;
627 elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr = (Elf_Internal_Shdr **)
628 bfd_alloc2 (abfd, num_group, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr *));
629 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr == NULL)
631 memset (elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr, 0,
632 num_group * sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr *));
635 for (i = 0; i < shnum; i++)
637 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
639 if (IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER (shdr, 2 * GRP_ENTRY_SIZE))
642 Elf_Internal_Group *dest;
644 /* Make sure the group section has a BFD section
646 if (!bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, i))
649 /* Add to list of sections. */
650 elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr[num_group] = shdr;
653 /* Read the raw contents. */
654 BFD_ASSERT (sizeof (*dest) >= 4);
655 amt = shdr->sh_size * sizeof (*dest) / 4;
656 shdr->contents = (unsigned char *)
657 bfd_alloc2 (abfd, shdr->sh_size, sizeof (*dest) / 4);
658 /* PR binutils/4110: Handle corrupt group headers. */
659 if (shdr->contents == NULL)
662 /* xgettext:c-format */
663 (_("%pB: corrupt size field in group section"
664 " header: %#" PRIx64),
665 abfd, (uint64_t) shdr->sh_size);
666 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
671 memset (shdr->contents, 0, amt);
673 if (bfd_seek (abfd, shdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
674 || (bfd_bread (shdr->contents, shdr->sh_size, abfd)
678 /* xgettext:c-format */
679 (_("%pB: invalid size field in group section"
680 " header: %#" PRIx64 ""),
681 abfd, (uint64_t) shdr->sh_size);
682 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
684 /* PR 17510: If the group contents are even
685 partially corrupt, do not allow any of the
686 contents to be used. */
687 memset (shdr->contents, 0, amt);
691 /* Translate raw contents, a flag word followed by an
692 array of elf section indices all in target byte order,
693 to the flag word followed by an array of elf section
695 src = shdr->contents + shdr->sh_size;
696 dest = (Elf_Internal_Group *) (shdr->contents + amt);
704 idx = H_GET_32 (abfd, src);
705 if (src == shdr->contents)
708 if (shdr->bfd_section != NULL && (idx & GRP_COMDAT))
709 shdr->bfd_section->flags
710 |= SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES_DISCARD;
715 dest->shdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[idx];
716 /* PR binutils/23199: All sections in a
717 section group should be marked with
718 SHF_GROUP. But some tools generate
719 broken objects without SHF_GROUP. Fix
721 dest->shdr->sh_flags |= SHF_GROUP;
724 || dest->shdr->sh_type == SHT_GROUP)
727 (_("%pB: invalid entry in SHT_GROUP section [%u]"),
735 /* PR 17510: Corrupt binaries might contain invalid groups. */
736 if (num_group != (unsigned) elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group)
738 elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group = num_group;
740 /* If all groups are invalid then fail. */
743 elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr = NULL;
744 elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group = num_group = -1;
746 (_("%pB: no valid group sections found"), abfd);
747 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
753 if (num_group != (unsigned) -1)
755 unsigned int search_offset = elf_tdata (abfd)->group_search_offset;
758 for (j = 0; j < num_group; j++)
760 /* Begin search from previous found group. */
761 unsigned i = (j + search_offset) % num_group;
763 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr[i];
764 Elf_Internal_Group *idx;
770 idx = (Elf_Internal_Group *) shdr->contents;
771 if (idx == NULL || shdr->sh_size < 4)
773 /* See PR 21957 for a reproducer. */
774 /* xgettext:c-format */
775 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: group section '%pA' has no contents"),
776 abfd, shdr->bfd_section);
777 elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr[i] = NULL;
778 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
781 n_elt = shdr->sh_size / 4;
783 /* Look through this group's sections to see if current
784 section is a member. */
786 if ((++idx)->shdr == hdr)
790 /* We are a member of this group. Go looking through
791 other members to see if any others are linked via
793 idx = (Elf_Internal_Group *) shdr->contents;
794 n_elt = shdr->sh_size / 4;
796 if ((++idx)->shdr != NULL
797 && (s = idx->shdr->bfd_section) != NULL
798 && elf_next_in_group (s) != NULL)
802 /* Snarf the group name from other member, and
803 insert current section in circular list. */
804 elf_group_name (newsect) = elf_group_name (s);
805 elf_next_in_group (newsect) = elf_next_in_group (s);
806 elf_next_in_group (s) = newsect;
812 gname = group_signature (abfd, shdr);
815 elf_group_name (newsect) = gname;
817 /* Start a circular list with one element. */
818 elf_next_in_group (newsect) = newsect;
821 /* If the group section has been created, point to the
823 if (shdr->bfd_section != NULL)
824 elf_next_in_group (shdr->bfd_section) = newsect;
826 elf_tdata (abfd)->group_search_offset = i;
833 if (elf_group_name (newsect) == NULL)
835 /* xgettext:c-format */
836 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: no group info for section '%pA'"),
844 _bfd_elf_setup_sections (bfd *abfd)
847 unsigned int num_group = elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group;
848 bfd_boolean result = TRUE;
851 /* Process SHF_LINK_ORDER. */
852 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
854 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr = &elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr;
855 if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_LINK_ORDER) != 0)
857 unsigned int elfsec = this_hdr->sh_link;
858 /* FIXME: The old Intel compiler and old strip/objcopy may
859 not set the sh_link or sh_info fields. Hence we could
860 get the situation where elfsec is 0. */
863 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
864 if (bed->link_order_error_handler)
865 bed->link_order_error_handler
866 /* xgettext:c-format */
867 (_("%pB: warning: sh_link not set for section `%pA'"),
872 asection *linksec = NULL;
874 if (elfsec < elf_numsections (abfd))
876 this_hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[elfsec];
877 linksec = this_hdr->bfd_section;
881 Some strip/objcopy may leave an incorrect value in
882 sh_link. We don't want to proceed. */
886 /* xgettext:c-format */
887 (_("%pB: sh_link [%d] in section `%pA' is incorrect"),
888 s->owner, elfsec, s);
892 elf_linked_to_section (s) = linksec;
895 else if (this_hdr->sh_type == SHT_GROUP
896 && elf_next_in_group (s) == NULL)
899 /* xgettext:c-format */
900 (_("%pB: SHT_GROUP section [index %d] has no SHF_GROUP sections"),
901 abfd, elf_section_data (s)->this_idx);
906 /* Process section groups. */
907 if (num_group == (unsigned) -1)
910 for (i = 0; i < num_group; i++)
912 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr[i];
913 Elf_Internal_Group *idx;
916 /* PR binutils/18758: Beware of corrupt binaries with invalid group data. */
917 if (shdr == NULL || shdr->bfd_section == NULL || shdr->contents == NULL)
920 /* xgettext:c-format */
921 (_("%pB: section group entry number %u is corrupt"),
927 idx = (Elf_Internal_Group *) shdr->contents;
928 n_elt = shdr->sh_size / 4;
934 if (idx->shdr == NULL)
936 else if (idx->shdr->bfd_section)
937 elf_sec_group (idx->shdr->bfd_section) = shdr->bfd_section;
938 else if (idx->shdr->sh_type != SHT_RELA
939 && idx->shdr->sh_type != SHT_REL)
941 /* There are some unknown sections in the group. */
943 /* xgettext:c-format */
944 (_("%pB: unknown type [%#x] section `%s' in group [%pA]"),
947 bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd,
948 (elf_elfheader (abfd)
961 bfd_elf_is_group_section (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, const asection *sec)
963 return elf_next_in_group (sec) != NULL;
967 convert_debug_to_zdebug (bfd *abfd, const char *name)
969 unsigned int len = strlen (name);
970 char *new_name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len + 2);
971 if (new_name == NULL)
975 memcpy (new_name + 2, name + 1, len);
980 convert_zdebug_to_debug (bfd *abfd, const char *name)
982 unsigned int len = strlen (name);
983 char *new_name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
984 if (new_name == NULL)
987 memcpy (new_name + 1, name + 2, len - 1);
991 /* Make a BFD section from an ELF section. We store a pointer to the
992 BFD section in the bfd_section field of the header. */
995 _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (bfd *abfd,
996 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr,
1002 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
1004 if (hdr->bfd_section != NULL)
1007 newsect = bfd_make_section_anyway (abfd, name);
1008 if (newsect == NULL)
1011 hdr->bfd_section = newsect;
1012 elf_section_data (newsect)->this_hdr = *hdr;
1013 elf_section_data (newsect)->this_idx = shindex;
1015 /* Always use the real type/flags. */
1016 elf_section_type (newsect) = hdr->sh_type;
1017 elf_section_flags (newsect) = hdr->sh_flags;
1019 newsect->filepos = hdr->sh_offset;
1021 if (! bfd_set_section_vma (abfd, newsect, hdr->sh_addr)
1022 || ! bfd_set_section_size (abfd, newsect, hdr->sh_size)
1023 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, newsect,
1024 bfd_log2 (hdr->sh_addralign)))
1027 flags = SEC_NO_FLAGS;
1028 if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
1029 flags |= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
1030 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_GROUP)
1032 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
1035 if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
1038 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_WRITE) == 0)
1039 flags |= SEC_READONLY;
1040 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXECINSTR) != 0)
1042 else if ((flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
1044 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_MERGE) != 0)
1047 newsect->entsize = hdr->sh_entsize;
1049 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_STRINGS) != 0)
1050 flags |= SEC_STRINGS;
1051 if (hdr->sh_flags & SHF_GROUP)
1052 if (!setup_group (abfd, hdr, newsect))
1054 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) != 0)
1055 flags |= SEC_THREAD_LOCAL;
1056 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXCLUDE) != 0)
1057 flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
1059 if ((flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0)
1061 /* The debugging sections appear to be recognized only by name,
1062 not any sort of flag. Their SEC_ALLOC bits are cleared. */
1063 if (name [0] == '.')
1068 p = ".debug", n = 6;
1069 else if (name[1] == 'g' && name[2] == 'n')
1070 p = ".gnu.linkonce.wi.", n = 17;
1071 else if (name[1] == 'g' && name[2] == 'd')
1072 p = ".gdb_index", n = 11; /* yes we really do mean 11. */
1073 else if (name[1] == 'l')
1075 else if (name[1] == 's')
1077 else if (name[1] == 'z')
1078 p = ".zdebug", n = 7;
1081 if (p != NULL && strncmp (name, p, n) == 0)
1082 flags |= SEC_DEBUGGING;
1086 /* As a GNU extension, if the name begins with .gnu.linkonce, we
1087 only link a single copy of the section. This is used to support
1088 g++. g++ will emit each template expansion in its own section.
1089 The symbols will be defined as weak, so that multiple definitions
1090 are permitted. The GNU linker extension is to actually discard
1091 all but one of the sections. */
1092 if (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".gnu.linkonce")
1093 && elf_next_in_group (newsect) == NULL)
1094 flags |= SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES_DISCARD;
1096 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
1097 if (bed->elf_backend_section_flags)
1098 if (! bed->elf_backend_section_flags (&flags, hdr))
1101 if (! bfd_set_section_flags (abfd, newsect, flags))
1104 /* We do not parse the PT_NOTE segments as we are interested even in the
1105 separate debug info files which may have the segments offsets corrupted.
1106 PT_NOTEs from the core files are currently not parsed using BFD. */
1107 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOTE)
1111 if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, newsect, &contents))
1114 elf_parse_notes (abfd, (char *) contents, hdr->sh_size,
1115 hdr->sh_offset, hdr->sh_addralign);
1119 if ((flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
1121 Elf_Internal_Phdr *phdr;
1122 unsigned int i, nload;
1124 /* Some ELF linkers produce binaries with all the program header
1125 p_paddr fields zero. If we have such a binary with more than
1126 one PT_LOAD header, then leave the section lma equal to vma
1127 so that we don't create sections with overlapping lma. */
1128 phdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
1129 for (nload = 0, i = 0; i < elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum; i++, phdr++)
1130 if (phdr->p_paddr != 0)
1132 else if (phdr->p_type == PT_LOAD && phdr->p_memsz != 0)
1134 if (i >= elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum && nload > 1)
1137 phdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
1138 for (i = 0; i < elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum; i++, phdr++)
1140 if (((phdr->p_type == PT_LOAD
1141 && (hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) == 0)
1142 || phdr->p_type == PT_TLS)
1143 && ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (hdr, phdr))
1145 if ((flags & SEC_LOAD) == 0)
1146 newsect->lma = (phdr->p_paddr
1147 + hdr->sh_addr - phdr->p_vaddr);
1149 /* We used to use the same adjustment for SEC_LOAD
1150 sections, but that doesn't work if the segment
1151 is packed with code from multiple VMAs.
1152 Instead we calculate the section LMA based on
1153 the segment LMA. It is assumed that the
1154 segment will contain sections with contiguous
1155 LMAs, even if the VMAs are not. */
1156 newsect->lma = (phdr->p_paddr
1157 + hdr->sh_offset - phdr->p_offset);
1159 /* With contiguous segments, we can't tell from file
1160 offsets whether a section with zero size should
1161 be placed at the end of one segment or the
1162 beginning of the next. Decide based on vaddr. */
1163 if (hdr->sh_addr >= phdr->p_vaddr
1164 && (hdr->sh_addr + hdr->sh_size
1165 <= phdr->p_vaddr + phdr->p_memsz))
1171 /* Compress/decompress DWARF debug sections with names: .debug_* and
1172 .zdebug_*, after the section flags is set. */
1173 if ((flags & SEC_DEBUGGING)
1174 && ((name[1] == 'd' && name[6] == '_')
1175 || (name[1] == 'z' && name[7] == '_')))
1177 enum { nothing, compress, decompress } action = nothing;
1178 int compression_header_size;
1179 bfd_size_type uncompressed_size;
1180 bfd_boolean compressed
1181 = bfd_is_section_compressed_with_header (abfd, newsect,
1182 &compression_header_size,
1183 &uncompressed_size);
1187 /* Compressed section. Check if we should decompress. */
1188 if ((abfd->flags & BFD_DECOMPRESS))
1189 action = decompress;
1192 /* Compress the uncompressed section or convert from/to .zdebug*
1193 section. Check if we should compress. */
1194 if (action == nothing)
1196 if (newsect->size != 0
1197 && (abfd->flags & BFD_COMPRESS)
1198 && compression_header_size >= 0
1199 && uncompressed_size > 0
1201 || ((compression_header_size > 0)
1202 != ((abfd->flags & BFD_COMPRESS_GABI) != 0))))
1208 if (action == compress)
1210 if (!bfd_init_section_compress_status (abfd, newsect))
1213 /* xgettext:c-format */
1214 (_("%pB: unable to initialize compress status for section %s"),
1221 if (!bfd_init_section_decompress_status (abfd, newsect))
1224 /* xgettext:c-format */
1225 (_("%pB: unable to initialize decompress status for section %s"),
1231 if (abfd->is_linker_input)
1234 && (action == decompress
1235 || (action == compress
1236 && (abfd->flags & BFD_COMPRESS_GABI) != 0)))
1238 /* Convert section name from .zdebug_* to .debug_* so
1239 that linker will consider this section as a debug
1241 char *new_name = convert_zdebug_to_debug (abfd, name);
1242 if (new_name == NULL)
1244 bfd_rename_section (abfd, newsect, new_name);
1248 /* For objdump, don't rename the section. For objcopy, delay
1249 section rename to elf_fake_sections. */
1250 newsect->flags |= SEC_ELF_RENAME;
1256 const char *const bfd_elf_section_type_names[] =
1258 "SHT_NULL", "SHT_PROGBITS", "SHT_SYMTAB", "SHT_STRTAB",
1259 "SHT_RELA", "SHT_HASH", "SHT_DYNAMIC", "SHT_NOTE",
1260 "SHT_NOBITS", "SHT_REL", "SHT_SHLIB", "SHT_DYNSYM",
1263 /* ELF relocs are against symbols. If we are producing relocatable
1264 output, and the reloc is against an external symbol, and nothing
1265 has given us any additional addend, the resulting reloc will also
1266 be against the same symbol. In such a case, we don't want to
1267 change anything about the way the reloc is handled, since it will
1268 all be done at final link time. Rather than put special case code
1269 into bfd_perform_relocation, all the reloc types use this howto
1270 function. It just short circuits the reloc if producing
1271 relocatable output against an external symbol. */
1273 bfd_reloc_status_type
1274 bfd_elf_generic_reloc (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1275 arelent *reloc_entry,
1277 void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1278 asection *input_section,
1280 char **error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1282 if (output_bfd != NULL
1283 && (symbol->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) == 0
1284 && (! reloc_entry->howto->partial_inplace
1285 || reloc_entry->addend == 0))
1287 reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
1288 return bfd_reloc_ok;
1291 return bfd_reloc_continue;
1294 /* Returns TRUE if section A matches section B.
1295 Names, addresses and links may be different, but everything else
1296 should be the same. */
1299 section_match (const Elf_Internal_Shdr * a,
1300 const Elf_Internal_Shdr * b)
1303 a->sh_type == b->sh_type
1304 && (a->sh_flags & ~ SHF_INFO_LINK)
1305 == (b->sh_flags & ~ SHF_INFO_LINK)
1306 && a->sh_addralign == b->sh_addralign
1307 && a->sh_size == b->sh_size
1308 && a->sh_entsize == b->sh_entsize
1309 /* FIXME: Check sh_addr ? */
1313 /* Find a section in OBFD that has the same characteristics
1314 as IHEADER. Return the index of this section or SHN_UNDEF if
1315 none can be found. Check's section HINT first, as this is likely
1316 to be the correct section. */
1319 find_link (const bfd *obfd, const Elf_Internal_Shdr *iheader,
1320 const unsigned int hint)
1322 Elf_Internal_Shdr ** oheaders = elf_elfsections (obfd);
1325 BFD_ASSERT (iheader != NULL);
1327 /* See PR 20922 for a reproducer of the NULL test. */
1328 if (hint < elf_numsections (obfd)
1329 && oheaders[hint] != NULL
1330 && section_match (oheaders[hint], iheader))
1333 for (i = 1; i < elf_numsections (obfd); i++)
1335 Elf_Internal_Shdr * oheader = oheaders[i];
1337 if (oheader == NULL)
1339 if (section_match (oheader, iheader))
1340 /* FIXME: Do we care if there is a potential for
1341 multiple matches ? */
1348 /* PR 19938: Attempt to set the ELF section header fields of an OS or
1349 Processor specific section, based upon a matching input section.
1350 Returns TRUE upon success, FALSE otherwise. */
1353 copy_special_section_fields (const bfd *ibfd,
1355 const Elf_Internal_Shdr *iheader,
1356 Elf_Internal_Shdr *oheader,
1357 const unsigned int secnum)
1359 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (obfd);
1360 const Elf_Internal_Shdr **iheaders = (const Elf_Internal_Shdr **) elf_elfsections (ibfd);
1361 bfd_boolean changed = FALSE;
1362 unsigned int sh_link;
1364 if (oheader->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS)
1366 /* This is a feature for objcopy --only-keep-debug:
1367 When a section's type is changed to NOBITS, we preserve
1368 the sh_link and sh_info fields so that they can be
1369 matched up with the original.
1371 Note: Strictly speaking these assignments are wrong.
1372 The sh_link and sh_info fields should point to the
1373 relevent sections in the output BFD, which may not be in
1374 the same location as they were in the input BFD. But
1375 the whole point of this action is to preserve the
1376 original values of the sh_link and sh_info fields, so
1377 that they can be matched up with the section headers in
1378 the original file. So strictly speaking we may be
1379 creating an invalid ELF file, but it is only for a file
1380 that just contains debug info and only for sections
1381 without any contents. */
1382 if (oheader->sh_link == 0)
1383 oheader->sh_link = iheader->sh_link;
1384 if (oheader->sh_info == 0)
1385 oheader->sh_info = iheader->sh_info;
1389 /* Allow the target a chance to decide how these fields should be set. */
1390 if (bed->elf_backend_copy_special_section_fields != NULL
1391 && bed->elf_backend_copy_special_section_fields
1392 (ibfd, obfd, iheader, oheader))
1395 /* We have an iheader which might match oheader, and which has non-zero
1396 sh_info and/or sh_link fields. Attempt to follow those links and find
1397 the section in the output bfd which corresponds to the linked section
1398 in the input bfd. */
1399 if (iheader->sh_link != SHN_UNDEF)
1401 /* See PR 20931 for a reproducer. */
1402 if (iheader->sh_link >= elf_numsections (ibfd))
1405 /* xgettext:c-format */
1406 (_("%pB: invalid sh_link field (%d) in section number %d"),
1407 ibfd, iheader->sh_link, secnum);
1411 sh_link = find_link (obfd, iheaders[iheader->sh_link], iheader->sh_link);
1412 if (sh_link != SHN_UNDEF)
1414 oheader->sh_link = sh_link;
1418 /* FIXME: Should we install iheader->sh_link
1419 if we could not find a match ? */
1421 /* xgettext:c-format */
1422 (_("%pB: failed to find link section for section %d"), obfd, secnum);
1425 if (iheader->sh_info)
1427 /* The sh_info field can hold arbitrary information, but if the
1428 SHF_LINK_INFO flag is set then it should be interpreted as a
1430 if (iheader->sh_flags & SHF_INFO_LINK)
1432 sh_link = find_link (obfd, iheaders[iheader->sh_info],
1434 if (sh_link != SHN_UNDEF)
1435 oheader->sh_flags |= SHF_INFO_LINK;
1438 /* No idea what it means - just copy it. */
1439 sh_link = iheader->sh_info;
1441 if (sh_link != SHN_UNDEF)
1443 oheader->sh_info = sh_link;
1448 /* xgettext:c-format */
1449 (_("%pB: failed to find info section for section %d"), obfd, secnum);
1455 /* Copy the program header and other data from one object module to
1459 _bfd_elf_copy_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
1461 const Elf_Internal_Shdr **iheaders = (const Elf_Internal_Shdr **) elf_elfsections (ibfd);
1462 Elf_Internal_Shdr **oheaders = elf_elfsections (obfd);
1463 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
1466 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
1467 || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
1470 if (!elf_flags_init (obfd))
1472 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_flags;
1473 elf_flags_init (obfd) = TRUE;
1476 elf_gp (obfd) = elf_gp (ibfd);
1478 /* Also copy the EI_OSABI field. */
1479 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_ident[EI_OSABI] =
1480 elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_OSABI];
1482 /* If set, copy the EI_ABIVERSION field. */
1483 if (elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_ABIVERSION])
1484 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_ident[EI_ABIVERSION]
1485 = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_ABIVERSION];
1487 /* Copy object attributes. */
1488 _bfd_elf_copy_obj_attributes (ibfd, obfd);
1490 if (iheaders == NULL || oheaders == NULL)
1493 bed = get_elf_backend_data (obfd);
1495 /* Possibly copy other fields in the section header. */
1496 for (i = 1; i < elf_numsections (obfd); i++)
1499 Elf_Internal_Shdr * oheader = oheaders[i];
1501 /* Ignore ordinary sections. SHT_NOBITS sections are considered however
1502 because of a special case need for generating separate debug info
1503 files. See below for more details. */
1505 || (oheader->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS
1506 && oheader->sh_type < SHT_LOOS))
1509 /* Ignore empty sections, and sections whose
1510 fields have already been initialised. */
1511 if (oheader->sh_size == 0
1512 || (oheader->sh_info != 0 && oheader->sh_link != 0))
1515 /* Scan for the matching section in the input bfd.
1516 First we try for a direct mapping between the input and output sections. */
1517 for (j = 1; j < elf_numsections (ibfd); j++)
1519 const Elf_Internal_Shdr * iheader = iheaders[j];
1521 if (iheader == NULL)
1524 if (oheader->bfd_section != NULL
1525 && iheader->bfd_section != NULL
1526 && iheader->bfd_section->output_section != NULL
1527 && iheader->bfd_section->output_section == oheader->bfd_section)
1529 /* We have found a connection from the input section to the
1530 output section. Attempt to copy the header fields. If
1531 this fails then do not try any further sections - there
1532 should only be a one-to-one mapping between input and output. */
1533 if (! copy_special_section_fields (ibfd, obfd, iheader, oheader, i))
1534 j = elf_numsections (ibfd);
1539 if (j < elf_numsections (ibfd))
1542 /* That failed. So try to deduce the corresponding input section.
1543 Unfortunately we cannot compare names as the output string table
1544 is empty, so instead we check size, address and type. */
1545 for (j = 1; j < elf_numsections (ibfd); j++)
1547 const Elf_Internal_Shdr * iheader = iheaders[j];
1549 if (iheader == NULL)
1552 /* Try matching fields in the input section's header.
1553 Since --only-keep-debug turns all non-debug sections into
1554 SHT_NOBITS sections, the output SHT_NOBITS type matches any
1556 if ((oheader->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS
1557 || iheader->sh_type == oheader->sh_type)
1558 && (iheader->sh_flags & ~ SHF_INFO_LINK)
1559 == (oheader->sh_flags & ~ SHF_INFO_LINK)
1560 && iheader->sh_addralign == oheader->sh_addralign
1561 && iheader->sh_entsize == oheader->sh_entsize
1562 && iheader->sh_size == oheader->sh_size
1563 && iheader->sh_addr == oheader->sh_addr
1564 && (iheader->sh_info != oheader->sh_info
1565 || iheader->sh_link != oheader->sh_link))
1567 if (copy_special_section_fields (ibfd, obfd, iheader, oheader, i))
1572 if (j == elf_numsections (ibfd) && oheader->sh_type >= SHT_LOOS)
1574 /* Final attempt. Call the backend copy function
1575 with a NULL input section. */
1576 if (bed->elf_backend_copy_special_section_fields != NULL)
1577 bed->elf_backend_copy_special_section_fields (ibfd, obfd, NULL, oheader);
1585 get_segment_type (unsigned int p_type)
1590 case PT_NULL: pt = "NULL"; break;
1591 case PT_LOAD: pt = "LOAD"; break;
1592 case PT_DYNAMIC: pt = "DYNAMIC"; break;
1593 case PT_INTERP: pt = "INTERP"; break;
1594 case PT_NOTE: pt = "NOTE"; break;
1595 case PT_SHLIB: pt = "SHLIB"; break;
1596 case PT_PHDR: pt = "PHDR"; break;
1597 case PT_TLS: pt = "TLS"; break;
1598 case PT_GNU_EH_FRAME: pt = "EH_FRAME"; break;
1599 case PT_GNU_STACK: pt = "STACK"; break;
1600 case PT_GNU_RELRO: pt = "RELRO"; break;
1601 default: pt = NULL; break;
1606 /* Print out the program headers. */
1609 _bfd_elf_print_private_bfd_data (bfd *abfd, void *farg)
1611 FILE *f = (FILE *) farg;
1612 Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
1614 bfd_byte *dynbuf = NULL;
1616 p = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
1621 fprintf (f, _("\nProgram Header:\n"));
1622 c = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum;
1623 for (i = 0; i < c; i++, p++)
1625 const char *pt = get_segment_type (p->p_type);
1630 sprintf (buf, "0x%lx", p->p_type);
1633 fprintf (f, "%8s off 0x", pt);
1634 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_offset);
1635 fprintf (f, " vaddr 0x");
1636 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_vaddr);
1637 fprintf (f, " paddr 0x");
1638 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_paddr);
1639 fprintf (f, " align 2**%u\n", bfd_log2 (p->p_align));
1640 fprintf (f, " filesz 0x");
1641 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_filesz);
1642 fprintf (f, " memsz 0x");
1643 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_memsz);
1644 fprintf (f, " flags %c%c%c",
1645 (p->p_flags & PF_R) != 0 ? 'r' : '-',
1646 (p->p_flags & PF_W) != 0 ? 'w' : '-',
1647 (p->p_flags & PF_X) != 0 ? 'x' : '-');
1648 if ((p->p_flags &~ (unsigned) (PF_R | PF_W | PF_X)) != 0)
1649 fprintf (f, " %lx", p->p_flags &~ (unsigned) (PF_R | PF_W | PF_X));
1654 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
1657 unsigned int elfsec;
1658 unsigned long shlink;
1659 bfd_byte *extdyn, *extdynend;
1661 void (*swap_dyn_in) (bfd *, const void *, Elf_Internal_Dyn *);
1663 fprintf (f, _("\nDynamic Section:\n"));
1665 if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, s, &dynbuf))
1668 elfsec = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (abfd, s);
1669 if (elfsec == SHN_BAD)
1671 shlink = elf_elfsections (abfd)[elfsec]->sh_link;
1673 extdynsize = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_dyn;
1674 swap_dyn_in = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->swap_dyn_in;
1677 /* PR 17512: file: 6f427532. */
1678 if (s->size < extdynsize)
1680 extdynend = extdyn + s->size;
1681 /* PR 17512: file: id:000006,sig:06,src:000000,op:flip4,pos:5664.
1683 for (; extdyn <= (extdynend - extdynsize); extdyn += extdynsize)
1685 Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
1686 const char *name = "";
1688 bfd_boolean stringp;
1689 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
1691 (*swap_dyn_in) (abfd, extdyn, &dyn);
1693 if (dyn.d_tag == DT_NULL)
1700 if (bed->elf_backend_get_target_dtag)
1701 name = (*bed->elf_backend_get_target_dtag) (dyn.d_tag);
1703 if (!strcmp (name, ""))
1705 sprintf (ab, "%#" BFD_VMA_FMT "x", dyn.d_tag);
1710 case DT_NEEDED: name = "NEEDED"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1711 case DT_PLTRELSZ: name = "PLTRELSZ"; break;
1712 case DT_PLTGOT: name = "PLTGOT"; break;
1713 case DT_HASH: name = "HASH"; break;
1714 case DT_STRTAB: name = "STRTAB"; break;
1715 case DT_SYMTAB: name = "SYMTAB"; break;
1716 case DT_RELA: name = "RELA"; break;
1717 case DT_RELASZ: name = "RELASZ"; break;
1718 case DT_RELAENT: name = "RELAENT"; break;
1719 case DT_STRSZ: name = "STRSZ"; break;
1720 case DT_SYMENT: name = "SYMENT"; break;
1721 case DT_INIT: name = "INIT"; break;
1722 case DT_FINI: name = "FINI"; break;
1723 case DT_SONAME: name = "SONAME"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1724 case DT_RPATH: name = "RPATH"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1725 case DT_SYMBOLIC: name = "SYMBOLIC"; break;
1726 case DT_REL: name = "REL"; break;
1727 case DT_RELSZ: name = "RELSZ"; break;
1728 case DT_RELENT: name = "RELENT"; break;
1729 case DT_PLTREL: name = "PLTREL"; break;
1730 case DT_DEBUG: name = "DEBUG"; break;
1731 case DT_TEXTREL: name = "TEXTREL"; break;
1732 case DT_JMPREL: name = "JMPREL"; break;
1733 case DT_BIND_NOW: name = "BIND_NOW"; break;
1734 case DT_INIT_ARRAY: name = "INIT_ARRAY"; break;
1735 case DT_FINI_ARRAY: name = "FINI_ARRAY"; break;
1736 case DT_INIT_ARRAYSZ: name = "INIT_ARRAYSZ"; break;
1737 case DT_FINI_ARRAYSZ: name = "FINI_ARRAYSZ"; break;
1738 case DT_RUNPATH: name = "RUNPATH"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1739 case DT_FLAGS: name = "FLAGS"; break;
1740 case DT_PREINIT_ARRAY: name = "PREINIT_ARRAY"; break;
1741 case DT_PREINIT_ARRAYSZ: name = "PREINIT_ARRAYSZ"; break;
1742 case DT_CHECKSUM: name = "CHECKSUM"; break;
1743 case DT_PLTPADSZ: name = "PLTPADSZ"; break;
1744 case DT_MOVEENT: name = "MOVEENT"; break;
1745 case DT_MOVESZ: name = "MOVESZ"; break;
1746 case DT_FEATURE: name = "FEATURE"; break;
1747 case DT_POSFLAG_1: name = "POSFLAG_1"; break;
1748 case DT_SYMINSZ: name = "SYMINSZ"; break;
1749 case DT_SYMINENT: name = "SYMINENT"; break;
1750 case DT_CONFIG: name = "CONFIG"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1751 case DT_DEPAUDIT: name = "DEPAUDIT"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1752 case DT_AUDIT: name = "AUDIT"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1753 case DT_PLTPAD: name = "PLTPAD"; break;
1754 case DT_MOVETAB: name = "MOVETAB"; break;
1755 case DT_SYMINFO: name = "SYMINFO"; break;
1756 case DT_RELACOUNT: name = "RELACOUNT"; break;
1757 case DT_RELCOUNT: name = "RELCOUNT"; break;
1758 case DT_FLAGS_1: name = "FLAGS_1"; break;
1759 case DT_VERSYM: name = "VERSYM"; break;
1760 case DT_VERDEF: name = "VERDEF"; break;
1761 case DT_VERDEFNUM: name = "VERDEFNUM"; break;
1762 case DT_VERNEED: name = "VERNEED"; break;
1763 case DT_VERNEEDNUM: name = "VERNEEDNUM"; break;
1764 case DT_AUXILIARY: name = "AUXILIARY"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1765 case DT_USED: name = "USED"; break;
1766 case DT_FILTER: name = "FILTER"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1767 case DT_GNU_HASH: name = "GNU_HASH"; break;
1770 fprintf (f, " %-20s ", name);
1774 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, dyn.d_un.d_val);
1779 unsigned int tagv = dyn.d_un.d_val;
1781 string = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, shlink, tagv);
1784 fprintf (f, "%s", string);
1793 if ((elf_dynverdef (abfd) != 0 && elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef == NULL)
1794 || (elf_dynverref (abfd) != 0 && elf_tdata (abfd)->verref == NULL))
1796 if (! _bfd_elf_slurp_version_tables (abfd, FALSE))
1800 if (elf_dynverdef (abfd) != 0)
1802 Elf_Internal_Verdef *t;
1804 fprintf (f, _("\nVersion definitions:\n"));
1805 for (t = elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef; t != NULL; t = t->vd_nextdef)
1807 fprintf (f, "%d 0x%2.2x 0x%8.8lx %s\n", t->vd_ndx,
1808 t->vd_flags, t->vd_hash,
1809 t->vd_nodename ? t->vd_nodename : "<corrupt>");
1810 if (t->vd_auxptr != NULL && t->vd_auxptr->vda_nextptr != NULL)
1812 Elf_Internal_Verdaux *a;
1815 for (a = t->vd_auxptr->vda_nextptr;
1819 a->vda_nodename ? a->vda_nodename : "<corrupt>");
1825 if (elf_dynverref (abfd) != 0)
1827 Elf_Internal_Verneed *t;
1829 fprintf (f, _("\nVersion References:\n"));
1830 for (t = elf_tdata (abfd)->verref; t != NULL; t = t->vn_nextref)
1832 Elf_Internal_Vernaux *a;
1834 fprintf (f, _(" required from %s:\n"),
1835 t->vn_filename ? t->vn_filename : "<corrupt>");
1836 for (a = t->vn_auxptr; a != NULL; a = a->vna_nextptr)
1837 fprintf (f, " 0x%8.8lx 0x%2.2x %2.2d %s\n", a->vna_hash,
1838 a->vna_flags, a->vna_other,
1839 a->vna_nodename ? a->vna_nodename : "<corrupt>");
1851 /* Get version string. */
1854 _bfd_elf_get_symbol_version_string (bfd *abfd, asymbol *symbol,
1855 bfd_boolean *hidden)
1857 const char *version_string = NULL;
1858 if (elf_dynversym (abfd) != 0
1859 && (elf_dynverdef (abfd) != 0 || elf_dynverref (abfd) != 0))
1861 unsigned int vernum = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->version;
1863 *hidden = (vernum & VERSYM_HIDDEN) != 0;
1864 vernum &= VERSYM_VERSION;
1867 version_string = "";
1868 else if (vernum == 1
1869 && (vernum > elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs
1870 || (elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef[0].vd_flags
1872 version_string = "Base";
1873 else if (vernum <= elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs)
1875 elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef[vernum - 1].vd_nodename;
1878 Elf_Internal_Verneed *t;
1880 version_string = _("<corrupt>");
1881 for (t = elf_tdata (abfd)->verref;
1885 Elf_Internal_Vernaux *a;
1887 for (a = t->vn_auxptr; a != NULL; a = a->vna_nextptr)
1889 if (a->vna_other == vernum)
1891 version_string = a->vna_nodename;
1898 return version_string;
1901 /* Display ELF-specific fields of a symbol. */
1904 bfd_elf_print_symbol (bfd *abfd,
1907 bfd_print_symbol_type how)
1909 FILE *file = (FILE *) filep;
1912 case bfd_print_symbol_name:
1913 fprintf (file, "%s", symbol->name);
1915 case bfd_print_symbol_more:
1916 fprintf (file, "elf ");
1917 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, file, symbol->value);
1918 fprintf (file, " %x", symbol->flags);
1920 case bfd_print_symbol_all:
1922 const char *section_name;
1923 const char *name = NULL;
1924 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
1925 unsigned char st_other;
1927 const char *version_string;
1930 section_name = symbol->section ? symbol->section->name : "(*none*)";
1932 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
1933 if (bed->elf_backend_print_symbol_all)
1934 name = (*bed->elf_backend_print_symbol_all) (abfd, filep, symbol);
1938 name = symbol->name;
1939 bfd_print_symbol_vandf (abfd, file, symbol);
1942 fprintf (file, " %s\t", section_name);
1943 /* Print the "other" value for a symbol. For common symbols,
1944 we've already printed the size; now print the alignment.
1945 For other symbols, we have no specified alignment, and
1946 we've printed the address; now print the size. */
1947 if (symbol->section && bfd_is_com_section (symbol->section))
1948 val = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->internal_elf_sym.st_value;
1950 val = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->internal_elf_sym.st_size;
1951 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, file, val);
1953 /* If we have version information, print it. */
1954 version_string = _bfd_elf_get_symbol_version_string (abfd,
1960 fprintf (file, " %-11s", version_string);
1965 fprintf (file, " (%s)", version_string);
1966 for (i = 10 - strlen (version_string); i > 0; --i)
1971 /* If the st_other field is not zero, print it. */
1972 st_other = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->internal_elf_sym.st_other;
1977 case STV_INTERNAL: fprintf (file, " .internal"); break;
1978 case STV_HIDDEN: fprintf (file, " .hidden"); break;
1979 case STV_PROTECTED: fprintf (file, " .protected"); break;
1981 /* Some other non-defined flags are also present, so print
1983 fprintf (file, " 0x%02x", (unsigned int) st_other);
1986 fprintf (file, " %s", name);
1992 /* ELF .o/exec file reading */
1994 /* Create a new bfd section from an ELF section header. */
1997 bfd_section_from_shdr (bfd *abfd, unsigned int shindex)
1999 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
2000 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *ehdr;
2001 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
2003 bfd_boolean ret = TRUE;
2004 static bfd_boolean * sections_being_created = NULL;
2005 static bfd * sections_being_created_abfd = NULL;
2006 static unsigned int nesting = 0;
2008 if (shindex >= elf_numsections (abfd))
2013 /* PR17512: A corrupt ELF binary might contain a recursive group of
2014 sections, with each the string indices pointing to the next in the
2015 loop. Detect this here, by refusing to load a section that we are
2016 already in the process of loading. We only trigger this test if
2017 we have nested at least three sections deep as normal ELF binaries
2018 can expect to recurse at least once.
2020 FIXME: It would be better if this array was attached to the bfd,
2021 rather than being held in a static pointer. */
2023 if (sections_being_created_abfd != abfd)
2024 sections_being_created = NULL;
2025 if (sections_being_created == NULL)
2027 /* FIXME: It would be more efficient to attach this array to the bfd somehow. */
2028 sections_being_created = (bfd_boolean *)
2029 bfd_zalloc (abfd, elf_numsections (abfd) * sizeof (bfd_boolean));
2030 sections_being_created_abfd = abfd;
2032 if (sections_being_created [shindex])
2035 (_("%pB: warning: loop in section dependencies detected"), abfd);
2038 sections_being_created [shindex] = TRUE;
2041 hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex];
2042 ehdr = elf_elfheader (abfd);
2043 name = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, ehdr->e_shstrndx,
2048 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
2049 switch (hdr->sh_type)
2052 /* Inactive section. Throw it away. */
2055 case SHT_PROGBITS: /* Normal section with contents. */
2056 case SHT_NOBITS: /* .bss section. */
2057 case SHT_HASH: /* .hash section. */
2058 case SHT_NOTE: /* .note section. */
2059 case SHT_INIT_ARRAY: /* .init_array section. */
2060 case SHT_FINI_ARRAY: /* .fini_array section. */
2061 case SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY: /* .preinit_array section. */
2062 case SHT_GNU_LIBLIST: /* .gnu.liblist section. */
2063 case SHT_GNU_HASH: /* .gnu.hash section. */
2064 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2067 case SHT_DYNAMIC: /* Dynamic linking information. */
2068 if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
2071 if (hdr->sh_link > elf_numsections (abfd))
2073 /* PR 10478: Accept Solaris binaries with a sh_link
2074 field set to SHN_BEFORE or SHN_AFTER. */
2075 switch (bfd_get_arch (abfd))
2078 case bfd_arch_sparc:
2079 if (hdr->sh_link == (SHN_LORESERVE & 0xffff) /* SHN_BEFORE */
2080 || hdr->sh_link == ((SHN_LORESERVE + 1) & 0xffff) /* SHN_AFTER */)
2082 /* Otherwise fall through. */
2087 else if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link] == NULL)
2089 else if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type != SHT_STRTAB)
2091 Elf_Internal_Shdr *dynsymhdr;
2093 /* The shared libraries distributed with hpux11 have a bogus
2094 sh_link field for the ".dynamic" section. Find the
2095 string table for the ".dynsym" section instead. */
2096 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) != 0)
2098 dynsymhdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[elf_dynsymtab (abfd)];
2099 hdr->sh_link = dynsymhdr->sh_link;
2103 unsigned int i, num_sec;
2105 num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
2106 for (i = 1; i < num_sec; i++)
2108 dynsymhdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
2109 if (dynsymhdr->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM)
2111 hdr->sh_link = dynsymhdr->sh_link;
2119 case SHT_SYMTAB: /* A symbol table. */
2120 if (elf_onesymtab (abfd) == shindex)
2123 if (hdr->sh_entsize != bed->s->sizeof_sym)
2126 if (hdr->sh_info * hdr->sh_entsize > hdr->sh_size)
2128 if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
2130 /* Some assemblers erroneously set sh_info to one with a
2131 zero sh_size. ld sees this as a global symbol count
2132 of (unsigned) -1. Fix it here. */
2137 /* PR 18854: A binary might contain more than one symbol table.
2138 Unusual, but possible. Warn, but continue. */
2139 if (elf_onesymtab (abfd) != 0)
2142 /* xgettext:c-format */
2143 (_("%pB: warning: multiple symbol tables detected"
2144 " - ignoring the table in section %u"),
2148 elf_onesymtab (abfd) = shindex;
2149 elf_symtab_hdr (abfd) = *hdr;
2150 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr = & elf_symtab_hdr (abfd);
2151 abfd->flags |= HAS_SYMS;
2153 /* Sometimes a shared object will map in the symbol table. If
2154 SHF_ALLOC is set, and this is a shared object, then we also
2155 treat this section as a BFD section. We can not base the
2156 decision purely on SHF_ALLOC, because that flag is sometimes
2157 set in a relocatable object file, which would confuse the
2159 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0
2160 && (abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0
2161 && ! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
2165 /* Go looking for SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX too, since if there is one we
2166 can't read symbols without that section loaded as well. It
2167 is most likely specified by the next section header. */
2169 elf_section_list * entry;
2170 unsigned int i, num_sec;
2172 for (entry = elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd); entry != NULL; entry = entry->next)
2173 if (entry->hdr.sh_link == shindex)
2176 num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
2177 for (i = shindex + 1; i < num_sec; i++)
2179 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2 = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
2181 if (hdr2->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX
2182 && hdr2->sh_link == shindex)
2187 for (i = 1; i < shindex; i++)
2189 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2 = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
2191 if (hdr2->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX
2192 && hdr2->sh_link == shindex)
2197 ret = bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, i);
2198 /* else FIXME: we have failed to find the symbol table - should we issue an error ? */
2202 case SHT_DYNSYM: /* A dynamic symbol table. */
2203 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == shindex)
2206 if (hdr->sh_entsize != bed->s->sizeof_sym)
2209 if (hdr->sh_info * hdr->sh_entsize > hdr->sh_size)
2211 if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
2214 /* Some linkers erroneously set sh_info to one with a
2215 zero sh_size. ld sees this as a global symbol count
2216 of (unsigned) -1. Fix it here. */
2221 /* PR 18854: A binary might contain more than one dynamic symbol table.
2222 Unusual, but possible. Warn, but continue. */
2223 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) != 0)
2226 /* xgettext:c-format */
2227 (_("%pB: warning: multiple dynamic symbol tables detected"
2228 " - ignoring the table in section %u"),
2232 elf_dynsymtab (abfd) = shindex;
2233 elf_tdata (abfd)->dynsymtab_hdr = *hdr;
2234 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynsymtab_hdr;
2235 abfd->flags |= HAS_SYMS;
2237 /* Besides being a symbol table, we also treat this as a regular
2238 section, so that objcopy can handle it. */
2239 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2242 case SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX: /* Symbol section indices when >64k sections. */
2244 elf_section_list * entry;
2246 for (entry = elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd); entry != NULL; entry = entry->next)
2247 if (entry->ndx == shindex)
2250 entry = bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof * entry);
2253 entry->ndx = shindex;
2255 entry->next = elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd);
2256 elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) = entry;
2257 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = & entry->hdr;
2261 case SHT_STRTAB: /* A string table. */
2262 if (hdr->bfd_section != NULL)
2265 if (ehdr->e_shstrndx == shindex)
2267 elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr = *hdr;
2268 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = &elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr;
2272 if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[elf_onesymtab (abfd)]->sh_link == shindex)
2275 elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr = *hdr;
2276 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = &elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr;
2280 if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[elf_dynsymtab (abfd)]->sh_link == shindex)
2283 elf_tdata (abfd)->dynstrtab_hdr = *hdr;
2284 hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynstrtab_hdr;
2285 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr;
2286 /* We also treat this as a regular section, so that objcopy
2288 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
2293 /* If the string table isn't one of the above, then treat it as a
2294 regular section. We need to scan all the headers to be sure,
2295 just in case this strtab section appeared before the above. */
2296 if (elf_onesymtab (abfd) == 0 || elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
2298 unsigned int i, num_sec;
2300 num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
2301 for (i = 1; i < num_sec; i++)
2303 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2 = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
2304 if (hdr2->sh_link == shindex)
2306 /* Prevent endless recursion on broken objects. */
2309 if (! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, i))
2311 if (elf_onesymtab (abfd) == i)
2313 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == i)
2314 goto dynsymtab_strtab;
2318 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2323 /* *These* do a lot of work -- but build no sections! */
2325 asection *target_sect;
2326 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2, **p_hdr;
2327 unsigned int num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
2328 struct bfd_elf_section_data *esdt;
2331 != (bfd_size_type) (hdr->sh_type == SHT_REL
2332 ? bed->s->sizeof_rel : bed->s->sizeof_rela))
2335 /* Check for a bogus link to avoid crashing. */
2336 if (hdr->sh_link >= num_sec)
2339 /* xgettext:c-format */
2340 (_("%pB: invalid link %u for reloc section %s (index %u)"),
2341 abfd, hdr->sh_link, name, shindex);
2342 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
2347 /* For some incomprehensible reason Oracle distributes
2348 libraries for Solaris in which some of the objects have
2349 bogus sh_link fields. It would be nice if we could just
2350 reject them, but, unfortunately, some people need to use
2351 them. We scan through the section headers; if we find only
2352 one suitable symbol table, we clobber the sh_link to point
2353 to it. I hope this doesn't break anything.
2355 Don't do it on executable nor shared library. */
2356 if ((abfd->flags & (DYNAMIC | EXEC_P)) == 0
2357 && elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type != SHT_SYMTAB
2358 && elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type != SHT_DYNSYM)
2364 for (scan = 1; scan < num_sec; scan++)
2366 if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[scan]->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB
2367 || elf_elfsections (abfd)[scan]->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM)
2378 hdr->sh_link = found;
2381 /* Get the symbol table. */
2382 if ((elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB
2383 || elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM)
2384 && ! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr->sh_link))
2387 /* If this reloc section does not use the main symbol table we
2388 don't treat it as a reloc section. BFD can't adequately
2389 represent such a section, so at least for now, we don't
2390 try. We just present it as a normal section. We also
2391 can't use it as a reloc section if it points to the null
2392 section, an invalid section, another reloc section, or its
2393 sh_link points to the null section. */
2394 if (hdr->sh_link != elf_onesymtab (abfd)
2395 || hdr->sh_link == SHN_UNDEF
2396 || hdr->sh_info == SHN_UNDEF
2397 || hdr->sh_info >= num_sec
2398 || elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_info]->sh_type == SHT_REL
2399 || elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_info]->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
2401 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
2406 if (! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr->sh_info))
2409 target_sect = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, hdr->sh_info);
2410 if (target_sect == NULL)
2413 esdt = elf_section_data (target_sect);
2414 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
2415 p_hdr = &esdt->rela.hdr;
2417 p_hdr = &esdt->rel.hdr;
2419 /* PR 17512: file: 0b4f81b7. */
2422 hdr2 = (Elf_Internal_Shdr *) bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof (*hdr2));
2427 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr2;
2428 target_sect->reloc_count += (NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (hdr)
2429 * bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel);
2430 target_sect->flags |= SEC_RELOC;
2431 target_sect->relocation = NULL;
2432 target_sect->rel_filepos = hdr->sh_offset;
2433 /* In the section to which the relocations apply, mark whether
2434 its relocations are of the REL or RELA variety. */
2435 if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
2437 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
2438 target_sect->use_rela_p = 1;
2440 abfd->flags |= HAS_RELOC;
2444 case SHT_GNU_verdef:
2445 elf_dynverdef (abfd) = shindex;
2446 elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverdef_hdr = *hdr;
2447 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2450 case SHT_GNU_versym:
2451 if (hdr->sh_entsize != sizeof (Elf_External_Versym))
2454 elf_dynversym (abfd) = shindex;
2455 elf_tdata (abfd)->dynversym_hdr = *hdr;
2456 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2459 case SHT_GNU_verneed:
2460 elf_dynverref (abfd) = shindex;
2461 elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverref_hdr = *hdr;
2462 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2469 if (! IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER (hdr, GRP_ENTRY_SIZE))
2472 if (!_bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
2478 /* Possibly an attributes section. */
2479 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_GNU_ATTRIBUTES
2480 || hdr->sh_type == bed->obj_attrs_section_type)
2482 if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
2484 _bfd_elf_parse_attributes (abfd, hdr);
2488 /* Check for any processor-specific section types. */
2489 if (bed->elf_backend_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
2492 if (hdr->sh_type >= SHT_LOUSER && hdr->sh_type <= SHT_HIUSER)
2494 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
2495 /* FIXME: How to properly handle allocated section reserved
2496 for applications? */
2498 /* xgettext:c-format */
2499 (_("%pB: unknown type [%#x] section `%s'"),
2500 abfd, hdr->sh_type, name);
2503 /* Allow sections reserved for applications. */
2504 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
2509 else if (hdr->sh_type >= SHT_LOPROC
2510 && hdr->sh_type <= SHT_HIPROC)
2511 /* FIXME: We should handle this section. */
2513 /* xgettext:c-format */
2514 (_("%pB: unknown type [%#x] section `%s'"),
2515 abfd, hdr->sh_type, name);
2516 else if (hdr->sh_type >= SHT_LOOS && hdr->sh_type <= SHT_HIOS)
2518 /* Unrecognised OS-specific sections. */
2519 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_OS_NONCONFORMING) != 0)
2520 /* SHF_OS_NONCONFORMING indicates that special knowledge is
2521 required to correctly process the section and the file should
2522 be rejected with an error message. */
2524 /* xgettext:c-format */
2525 (_("%pB: unknown type [%#x] section `%s'"),
2526 abfd, hdr->sh_type, name);
2529 /* Otherwise it should be processed. */
2530 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2535 /* FIXME: We should handle this section. */
2537 /* xgettext:c-format */
2538 (_("%pB: unknown type [%#x] section `%s'"),
2539 abfd, hdr->sh_type, name);
2547 if (sections_being_created && sections_being_created_abfd == abfd)
2548 sections_being_created [shindex] = FALSE;
2549 if (-- nesting == 0)
2551 sections_being_created = NULL;
2552 sections_being_created_abfd = abfd;
2557 /* Return the local symbol specified by ABFD, R_SYMNDX. */
2560 bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (struct sym_cache *cache,
2562 unsigned long r_symndx)
2564 unsigned int ent = r_symndx % LOCAL_SYM_CACHE_SIZE;
2566 if (cache->abfd != abfd || cache->indx[ent] != r_symndx)
2568 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
2569 unsigned char esym[sizeof (Elf64_External_Sym)];
2570 Elf_External_Sym_Shndx eshndx;
2572 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
2573 if (bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (abfd, symtab_hdr, 1, r_symndx,
2574 &cache->sym[ent], esym, &eshndx) == NULL)
2577 if (cache->abfd != abfd)
2579 memset (cache->indx, -1, sizeof (cache->indx));
2582 cache->indx[ent] = r_symndx;
2585 return &cache->sym[ent];
2588 /* Given an ELF section number, retrieve the corresponding BFD
2592 bfd_section_from_elf_index (bfd *abfd, unsigned int sec_index)
2594 if (sec_index >= elf_numsections (abfd))
2596 return elf_elfsections (abfd)[sec_index]->bfd_section;
2599 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_b[] =
2601 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".bss"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2602 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2605 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_c[] =
2607 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".comment"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2608 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2611 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_d[] =
2613 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".data"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2614 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".data1"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2615 /* There are more DWARF sections than these, but they needn't be added here
2616 unless you have to cope with broken compilers that don't emit section
2617 attributes or you want to help the user writing assembler. */
2618 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2619 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_line"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2620 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_info"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2621 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_abbrev"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2622 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_aranges"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2623 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".dynamic"), 0, SHT_DYNAMIC, SHF_ALLOC },
2624 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".dynstr"), 0, SHT_STRTAB, SHF_ALLOC },
2625 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".dynsym"), 0, SHT_DYNSYM, SHF_ALLOC },
2626 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2629 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_f[] =
2631 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".fini"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
2632 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".fini_array"), -2, SHT_FINI_ARRAY, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2633 { NULL, 0 , 0, 0, 0 }
2636 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_g[] =
2638 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.linkonce.b"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2639 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.lto_"), -1, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_EXCLUDE },
2640 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".got"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2641 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.version"), 0, SHT_GNU_versym, 0 },
2642 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.version_d"), 0, SHT_GNU_verdef, 0 },
2643 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.version_r"), 0, SHT_GNU_verneed, 0 },
2644 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.liblist"), 0, SHT_GNU_LIBLIST, SHF_ALLOC },
2645 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.conflict"), 0, SHT_RELA, SHF_ALLOC },
2646 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.hash"), 0, SHT_GNU_HASH, SHF_ALLOC },
2647 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2650 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_h[] =
2652 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".hash"), 0, SHT_HASH, SHF_ALLOC },
2653 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2656 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_i[] =
2658 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".init"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
2659 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".init_array"), -2, SHT_INIT_ARRAY, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2660 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".interp"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2661 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2664 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_l[] =
2666 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".line"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2667 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2670 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_n[] =
2672 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".note.GNU-stack"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2673 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".note"), -1, SHT_NOTE, 0 },
2674 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2677 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_p[] =
2679 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".preinit_array"), -2, SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2680 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".plt"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
2681 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2684 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_r[] =
2686 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rodata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
2687 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rodata1"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
2688 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rela"), -1, SHT_RELA, 0 },
2689 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rel"), -1, SHT_REL, 0 },
2690 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2693 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_s[] =
2695 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".shstrtab"), 0, SHT_STRTAB, 0 },
2696 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".strtab"), 0, SHT_STRTAB, 0 },
2697 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".symtab"), 0, SHT_SYMTAB, 0 },
2698 /* See struct bfd_elf_special_section declaration for the semantics of
2699 this special case where .prefix_length != strlen (.prefix). */
2700 { ".stabstr", 5, 3, SHT_STRTAB, 0 },
2701 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2704 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_t[] =
2706 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".text"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
2707 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".tbss"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_TLS },
2708 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".tdata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_TLS },
2709 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2712 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_z[] =
2714 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_line"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2715 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_info"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2716 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_abbrev"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2717 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_aranges"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2718 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2721 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section * const special_sections[] =
2723 special_sections_b, /* 'b' */
2724 special_sections_c, /* 'c' */
2725 special_sections_d, /* 'd' */
2727 special_sections_f, /* 'f' */
2728 special_sections_g, /* 'g' */
2729 special_sections_h, /* 'h' */
2730 special_sections_i, /* 'i' */
2733 special_sections_l, /* 'l' */
2735 special_sections_n, /* 'n' */
2737 special_sections_p, /* 'p' */
2739 special_sections_r, /* 'r' */
2740 special_sections_s, /* 's' */
2741 special_sections_t, /* 't' */
2747 special_sections_z /* 'z' */
2750 const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
2751 _bfd_elf_get_special_section (const char *name,
2752 const struct bfd_elf_special_section *spec,
2758 len = strlen (name);
2760 for (i = 0; spec[i].prefix != NULL; i++)
2763 int prefix_len = spec[i].prefix_length;
2765 if (len < prefix_len)
2767 if (memcmp (name, spec[i].prefix, prefix_len) != 0)
2770 suffix_len = spec[i].suffix_length;
2771 if (suffix_len <= 0)
2773 if (name[prefix_len] != 0)
2775 if (suffix_len == 0)
2777 if (name[prefix_len] != '.'
2778 && (suffix_len == -2
2779 || (rela && spec[i].type == SHT_REL)))
2785 if (len < prefix_len + suffix_len)
2787 if (memcmp (name + len - suffix_len,
2788 spec[i].prefix + prefix_len,
2798 const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
2799 _bfd_elf_get_sec_type_attr (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
2802 const struct bfd_elf_special_section *spec;
2803 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
2805 /* See if this is one of the special sections. */
2806 if (sec->name == NULL)
2809 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
2810 spec = bed->special_sections;
2813 spec = _bfd_elf_get_special_section (sec->name,
2814 bed->special_sections,
2820 if (sec->name[0] != '.')
2823 i = sec->name[1] - 'b';
2824 if (i < 0 || i > 'z' - 'b')
2827 spec = special_sections[i];
2832 return _bfd_elf_get_special_section (sec->name, spec, sec->use_rela_p);
2836 _bfd_elf_new_section_hook (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
2838 struct bfd_elf_section_data *sdata;
2839 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
2840 const struct bfd_elf_special_section *ssect;
2842 sdata = (struct bfd_elf_section_data *) sec->used_by_bfd;
2845 sdata = (struct bfd_elf_section_data *) bfd_zalloc (abfd,
2849 sec->used_by_bfd = sdata;
2852 /* Indicate whether or not this section should use RELA relocations. */
2853 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
2854 sec->use_rela_p = bed->default_use_rela_p;
2856 /* When we read a file, we don't need to set ELF section type and
2857 flags. They will be overridden in _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr
2858 anyway. We will set ELF section type and flags for all linker
2859 created sections. If user specifies BFD section flags, we will
2860 set ELF section type and flags based on BFD section flags in
2861 elf_fake_sections. Special handling for .init_array/.fini_array
2862 output sections since they may contain .ctors/.dtors input
2863 sections. We don't want _bfd_elf_init_private_section_data to
2864 copy ELF section type from .ctors/.dtors input sections. */
2865 if (abfd->direction != read_direction
2866 || (sec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) != 0)
2868 ssect = (*bed->get_sec_type_attr) (abfd, sec);
2871 || (sec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) != 0
2872 || ssect->type == SHT_INIT_ARRAY
2873 || ssect->type == SHT_FINI_ARRAY))
2875 elf_section_type (sec) = ssect->type;
2876 elf_section_flags (sec) = ssect->attr;
2880 return _bfd_generic_new_section_hook (abfd, sec);
2883 /* Create a new bfd section from an ELF program header.
2885 Since program segments have no names, we generate a synthetic name
2886 of the form segment<NUM>, where NUM is generally the index in the
2887 program header table. For segments that are split (see below) we
2888 generate the names segment<NUM>a and segment<NUM>b.
2890 Note that some program segments may have a file size that is different than
2891 (less than) the memory size. All this means is that at execution the
2892 system must allocate the amount of memory specified by the memory size,
2893 but only initialize it with the first "file size" bytes read from the
2894 file. This would occur for example, with program segments consisting
2895 of combined data+bss.
2897 To handle the above situation, this routine generates TWO bfd sections
2898 for the single program segment. The first has the length specified by
2899 the file size of the segment, and the second has the length specified
2900 by the difference between the two sizes. In effect, the segment is split
2901 into its initialized and uninitialized parts.
2906 _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (bfd *abfd,
2907 Elf_Internal_Phdr *hdr,
2909 const char *type_name)
2917 split = ((hdr->p_memsz > 0)
2918 && (hdr->p_filesz > 0)
2919 && (hdr->p_memsz > hdr->p_filesz));
2921 if (hdr->p_filesz > 0)
2923 sprintf (namebuf, "%s%d%s", type_name, hdr_index, split ? "a" : "");
2924 len = strlen (namebuf) + 1;
2925 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
2928 memcpy (name, namebuf, len);
2929 newsect = bfd_make_section (abfd, name);
2930 if (newsect == NULL)
2932 newsect->vma = hdr->p_vaddr;
2933 newsect->lma = hdr->p_paddr;
2934 newsect->size = hdr->p_filesz;
2935 newsect->filepos = hdr->p_offset;
2936 newsect->flags |= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
2937 newsect->alignment_power = bfd_log2 (hdr->p_align);
2938 if (hdr->p_type == PT_LOAD)
2940 newsect->flags |= SEC_ALLOC;
2941 newsect->flags |= SEC_LOAD;
2942 if (hdr->p_flags & PF_X)
2944 /* FIXME: all we known is that it has execute PERMISSION,
2946 newsect->flags |= SEC_CODE;
2949 if (!(hdr->p_flags & PF_W))
2951 newsect->flags |= SEC_READONLY;
2955 if (hdr->p_memsz > hdr->p_filesz)
2959 sprintf (namebuf, "%s%d%s", type_name, hdr_index, split ? "b" : "");
2960 len = strlen (namebuf) + 1;
2961 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
2964 memcpy (name, namebuf, len);
2965 newsect = bfd_make_section (abfd, name);
2966 if (newsect == NULL)
2968 newsect->vma = hdr->p_vaddr + hdr->p_filesz;
2969 newsect->lma = hdr->p_paddr + hdr->p_filesz;
2970 newsect->size = hdr->p_memsz - hdr->p_filesz;
2971 newsect->filepos = hdr->p_offset + hdr->p_filesz;
2972 align = newsect->vma & -newsect->vma;
2973 if (align == 0 || align > hdr->p_align)
2974 align = hdr->p_align;
2975 newsect->alignment_power = bfd_log2 (align);
2976 if (hdr->p_type == PT_LOAD)
2978 /* Hack for gdb. Segments that have not been modified do
2979 not have their contents written to a core file, on the
2980 assumption that a debugger can find the contents in the
2981 executable. We flag this case by setting the fake
2982 section size to zero. Note that "real" bss sections will
2983 always have their contents dumped to the core file. */
2984 if (bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core)
2986 newsect->flags |= SEC_ALLOC;
2987 if (hdr->p_flags & PF_X)
2988 newsect->flags |= SEC_CODE;
2990 if (!(hdr->p_flags & PF_W))
2991 newsect->flags |= SEC_READONLY;
2998 bfd_section_from_phdr (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Phdr *hdr, int hdr_index)
3000 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
3002 switch (hdr->p_type)
3005 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "null");
3008 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "load");
3011 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "dynamic");
3014 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "interp");
3017 if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "note"))
3019 if (! elf_read_notes (abfd, hdr->p_offset, hdr->p_filesz,
3025 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "shlib");
3028 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "phdr");
3030 case PT_GNU_EH_FRAME:
3031 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index,
3035 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "stack");
3038 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "relro");
3041 /* Check for any processor-specific program segment types. */
3042 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3043 return bed->elf_backend_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "proc");
3047 /* Return the REL_HDR for SEC, assuming there is only a single one, either
3051 _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (asection *sec)
3053 if (elf_section_data (sec)->rel.hdr)
3055 BFD_ASSERT (elf_section_data (sec)->rela.hdr == NULL);
3056 return elf_section_data (sec)->rel.hdr;
3059 return elf_section_data (sec)->rela.hdr;
3063 _bfd_elf_set_reloc_sh_name (bfd *abfd,
3064 Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr,
3065 const char *sec_name,
3066 bfd_boolean use_rela_p)
3068 char *name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd,
3069 sizeof ".rela" + strlen (sec_name));
3073 sprintf (name, "%s%s", use_rela_p ? ".rela" : ".rel", sec_name);
3075 (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd), name,
3077 if (rel_hdr->sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
3083 /* Allocate and initialize a section-header for a new reloc section,
3084 containing relocations against ASECT. It is stored in RELDATA. If
3085 USE_RELA_P is TRUE, we use RELA relocations; otherwise, we use REL
3089 _bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (bfd *abfd,
3090 struct bfd_elf_section_reloc_data *reldata,
3091 const char *sec_name,
3092 bfd_boolean use_rela_p,
3093 bfd_boolean delay_st_name_p)
3095 Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
3096 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3098 BFD_ASSERT (reldata->hdr == NULL);
3099 rel_hdr = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (*rel_hdr));
3100 reldata->hdr = rel_hdr;
3102 if (delay_st_name_p)
3103 rel_hdr->sh_name = (unsigned int) -1;
3104 else if (!_bfd_elf_set_reloc_sh_name (abfd, rel_hdr, sec_name,
3107 rel_hdr->sh_type = use_rela_p ? SHT_RELA : SHT_REL;
3108 rel_hdr->sh_entsize = (use_rela_p
3109 ? bed->s->sizeof_rela
3110 : bed->s->sizeof_rel);
3111 rel_hdr->sh_addralign = (bfd_vma) 1 << bed->s->log_file_align;
3112 rel_hdr->sh_flags = 0;
3113 rel_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
3114 rel_hdr->sh_size = 0;
3115 rel_hdr->sh_offset = 0;
3120 /* Return the default section type based on the passed in section flags. */
3123 bfd_elf_get_default_section_type (flagword flags)
3125 if ((flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
3126 && (flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS)) == 0)
3128 return SHT_PROGBITS;
3131 struct fake_section_arg
3133 struct bfd_link_info *link_info;
3137 /* Set up an ELF internal section header for a section. */
3140 elf_fake_sections (bfd *abfd, asection *asect, void *fsarg)
3142 struct fake_section_arg *arg = (struct fake_section_arg *)fsarg;
3143 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3144 struct bfd_elf_section_data *esd = elf_section_data (asect);
3145 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
3146 unsigned int sh_type;
3147 const char *name = asect->name;
3148 bfd_boolean delay_st_name_p = FALSE;
3152 /* We already failed; just get out of the bfd_map_over_sections
3157 this_hdr = &esd->this_hdr;
3161 /* ld: compress DWARF debug sections with names: .debug_*. */
3162 if ((arg->link_info->compress_debug & COMPRESS_DEBUG)
3163 && (asect->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING)
3167 /* Set SEC_ELF_COMPRESS to indicate this section should be
3169 asect->flags |= SEC_ELF_COMPRESS;
3171 /* If this section will be compressed, delay adding section
3172 name to section name section after it is compressed in
3173 _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load. */
3174 delay_st_name_p = TRUE;
3177 else if ((asect->flags & SEC_ELF_RENAME))
3179 /* objcopy: rename output DWARF debug section. */
3180 if ((abfd->flags & (BFD_DECOMPRESS | BFD_COMPRESS_GABI)))
3182 /* When we decompress or compress with SHF_COMPRESSED,
3183 convert section name from .zdebug_* to .debug_* if
3187 char *new_name = convert_zdebug_to_debug (abfd, name);
3188 if (new_name == NULL)
3196 else if (asect->compress_status == COMPRESS_SECTION_DONE)
3198 /* PR binutils/18087: Compression does not always make a
3199 section smaller. So only rename the section when
3200 compression has actually taken place. If input section
3201 name is .zdebug_*, we should never compress it again. */
3202 char *new_name = convert_debug_to_zdebug (abfd, name);
3203 if (new_name == NULL)
3208 BFD_ASSERT (name[1] != 'z');
3213 if (delay_st_name_p)
3214 this_hdr->sh_name = (unsigned int) -1;
3218 = (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd),
3220 if (this_hdr->sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
3227 /* Don't clear sh_flags. Assembler may set additional bits. */
3229 if ((asect->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
3230 || asect->user_set_vma)
3231 this_hdr->sh_addr = asect->vma;
3233 this_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
3235 this_hdr->sh_offset = 0;
3236 this_hdr->sh_size = asect->size;
3237 this_hdr->sh_link = 0;
3238 /* PR 17512: file: 0eb809fe, 8b0535ee. */
3239 if (asect->alignment_power >= (sizeof (bfd_vma) * 8) - 1)
3242 /* xgettext:c-format */
3243 (_("%pB: error: alignment power %d of section `%pA' is too big"),
3244 abfd, asect->alignment_power, asect);
3248 this_hdr->sh_addralign = (bfd_vma) 1 << asect->alignment_power;
3249 /* The sh_entsize and sh_info fields may have been set already by
3250 copy_private_section_data. */
3252 this_hdr->bfd_section = asect;
3253 this_hdr->contents = NULL;
3255 /* If the section type is unspecified, we set it based on
3257 if ((asect->flags & SEC_GROUP) != 0)
3258 sh_type = SHT_GROUP;
3260 sh_type = bfd_elf_get_default_section_type (asect->flags);
3262 if (this_hdr->sh_type == SHT_NULL)
3263 this_hdr->sh_type = sh_type;
3264 else if (this_hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS
3265 && sh_type == SHT_PROGBITS
3266 && (asect->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
3268 /* Warn if we are changing a NOBITS section to PROGBITS, but
3269 allow the link to proceed. This can happen when users link
3270 non-bss input sections to bss output sections, or emit data
3271 to a bss output section via a linker script. */
3273 (_("warning: section `%pA' type changed to PROGBITS"), asect);
3274 this_hdr->sh_type = sh_type;
3277 switch (this_hdr->sh_type)
3288 case SHT_INIT_ARRAY:
3289 case SHT_FINI_ARRAY:
3290 case SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY:
3291 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->arch_size / 8;
3295 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_hash_entry;
3299 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_sym;
3303 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_dyn;
3307 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->may_use_rela_p)
3308 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_rela;
3312 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->may_use_rel_p)
3313 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_rel;
3316 case SHT_GNU_versym:
3317 this_hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf_External_Versym);
3320 case SHT_GNU_verdef:
3321 this_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
3322 /* objcopy or strip will copy over sh_info, but may not set
3323 cverdefs. The linker will set cverdefs, but sh_info will be
3325 if (this_hdr->sh_info == 0)
3326 this_hdr->sh_info = elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs;
3328 BFD_ASSERT (elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs == 0
3329 || this_hdr->sh_info == elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs);
3332 case SHT_GNU_verneed:
3333 this_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
3334 /* objcopy or strip will copy over sh_info, but may not set
3335 cverrefs. The linker will set cverrefs, but sh_info will be
3337 if (this_hdr->sh_info == 0)
3338 this_hdr->sh_info = elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs;
3340 BFD_ASSERT (elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs == 0
3341 || this_hdr->sh_info == elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs);
3345 this_hdr->sh_entsize = GRP_ENTRY_SIZE;
3349 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->arch_size == 64 ? 0 : 4;
3353 if ((asect->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
3354 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_ALLOC;
3355 if ((asect->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
3356 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_WRITE;
3357 if ((asect->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
3358 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_EXECINSTR;
3359 if ((asect->flags & SEC_MERGE) != 0)
3361 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MERGE;
3362 this_hdr->sh_entsize = asect->entsize;
3364 if ((asect->flags & SEC_STRINGS) != 0)
3365 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_STRINGS;
3366 if ((asect->flags & SEC_GROUP) == 0 && elf_group_name (asect) != NULL)
3367 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_GROUP;
3368 if ((asect->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)
3370 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_TLS;
3371 if (asect->size == 0
3372 && (asect->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) == 0)
3374 struct bfd_link_order *o = asect->map_tail.link_order;
3376 this_hdr->sh_size = 0;
3379 this_hdr->sh_size = o->offset + o->size;
3380 if (this_hdr->sh_size != 0)
3381 this_hdr->sh_type = SHT_NOBITS;
3385 if ((asect->flags & (SEC_GROUP | SEC_EXCLUDE)) == SEC_EXCLUDE)
3386 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_EXCLUDE;
3388 /* If the section has relocs, set up a section header for the
3389 SHT_REL[A] section. If two relocation sections are required for
3390 this section, it is up to the processor-specific back-end to
3391 create the other. */
3392 if ((asect->flags & SEC_RELOC) != 0)
3394 /* When doing a relocatable link, create both REL and RELA sections if
3397 /* Do the normal setup if we wouldn't create any sections here. */
3398 && esd->rel.count + esd->rela.count > 0
3399 && (bfd_link_relocatable (arg->link_info)
3400 || arg->link_info->emitrelocations))
3402 if (esd->rel.count && esd->rel.hdr == NULL
3403 && !_bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (abfd, &esd->rel, name,
3404 FALSE, delay_st_name_p))
3409 if (esd->rela.count && esd->rela.hdr == NULL
3410 && !_bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (abfd, &esd->rela, name,
3411 TRUE, delay_st_name_p))
3417 else if (!_bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (abfd,
3419 ? &esd->rela : &esd->rel),
3429 /* Check for processor-specific section types. */
3430 sh_type = this_hdr->sh_type;
3431 if (bed->elf_backend_fake_sections
3432 && !(*bed->elf_backend_fake_sections) (abfd, this_hdr, asect))
3438 if (sh_type == SHT_NOBITS && asect->size != 0)
3440 /* Don't change the header type from NOBITS if we are being
3441 called for objcopy --only-keep-debug. */
3442 this_hdr->sh_type = sh_type;
3446 /* Fill in the contents of a SHT_GROUP section. Called from
3447 _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions for gas, objcopy, and
3448 when ELF targets use the generic linker, ld. Called for ld -r
3449 from bfd_elf_final_link. */
3452 bfd_elf_set_group_contents (bfd *abfd, asection *sec, void *failedptrarg)
3454 bfd_boolean *failedptr = (bfd_boolean *) failedptrarg;
3455 asection *elt, *first;
3459 /* Ignore linker created group section. See elfNN_ia64_object_p in
3461 if (((sec->flags & (SEC_GROUP | SEC_LINKER_CREATED)) != SEC_GROUP)
3465 if (elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info == 0)
3467 unsigned long symindx = 0;
3469 /* elf_group_id will have been set up by objcopy and the
3471 if (elf_group_id (sec) != NULL)
3472 symindx = elf_group_id (sec)->udata.i;
3476 /* If called from the assembler, swap_out_syms will have set up
3477 elf_section_syms. */
3478 BFD_ASSERT (elf_section_syms (abfd) != NULL);
3479 symindx = elf_section_syms (abfd)[sec->index]->udata.i;
3481 elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info = symindx;
3483 else if (elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info == (unsigned int) -2)
3485 /* The ELF backend linker sets sh_info to -2 when the group
3486 signature symbol is global, and thus the index can't be
3487 set until all local symbols are output. */
3489 struct bfd_elf_section_data *sec_data;
3490 unsigned long symndx;
3491 unsigned long extsymoff;
3492 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
3494 /* The point of this little dance to the first SHF_GROUP section
3495 then back to the SHT_GROUP section is that this gets us to
3496 the SHT_GROUP in the input object. */
3497 igroup = elf_sec_group (elf_next_in_group (sec));
3498 sec_data = elf_section_data (igroup);
3499 symndx = sec_data->this_hdr.sh_info;
3501 if (!elf_bad_symtab (igroup->owner))
3503 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
3505 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (igroup->owner)->symtab_hdr;
3506 extsymoff = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
3508 h = elf_sym_hashes (igroup->owner)[symndx - extsymoff];
3509 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
3510 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
3511 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
3513 elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info = h->indx;
3516 /* The contents won't be allocated for "ld -r" or objcopy. */
3518 if (sec->contents == NULL)
3521 sec->contents = (unsigned char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, sec->size);
3523 /* Arrange for the section to be written out. */
3524 elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents = sec->contents;
3525 if (sec->contents == NULL)
3532 loc = sec->contents + sec->size;
3534 /* Get the pointer to the first section in the group that gas
3535 squirreled away here. objcopy arranges for this to be set to the
3536 start of the input section group. */
3537 first = elt = elf_next_in_group (sec);
3539 /* First element is a flag word. Rest of section is elf section
3540 indices for all the sections of the group. Write them backwards
3541 just to keep the group in the same order as given in .section
3542 directives, not that it matters. */
3549 s = s->output_section;
3551 && !bfd_is_abs_section (s))
3553 struct bfd_elf_section_data *elf_sec = elf_section_data (s);
3554 struct bfd_elf_section_data *input_elf_sec = elf_section_data (elt);
3556 if (elf_sec->rel.hdr != NULL
3558 || (input_elf_sec->rel.hdr != NULL
3559 && input_elf_sec->rel.hdr->sh_flags & SHF_GROUP) != 0))
3561 elf_sec->rel.hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_GROUP;
3563 H_PUT_32 (abfd, elf_sec->rel.idx, loc);
3565 if (elf_sec->rela.hdr != NULL
3567 || (input_elf_sec->rela.hdr != NULL
3568 && input_elf_sec->rela.hdr->sh_flags & SHF_GROUP) != 0))
3570 elf_sec->rela.hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_GROUP;
3572 H_PUT_32 (abfd, elf_sec->rela.idx, loc);
3575 H_PUT_32 (abfd, elf_sec->this_idx, loc);
3577 elt = elf_next_in_group (elt);
3583 BFD_ASSERT (loc == sec->contents);
3585 H_PUT_32 (abfd, sec->flags & SEC_LINK_ONCE ? GRP_COMDAT : 0, loc);
3588 /* Given NAME, the name of a relocation section stripped of its
3589 .rel/.rela prefix, return the section in ABFD to which the
3590 relocations apply. */
3593 _bfd_elf_plt_get_reloc_section (bfd *abfd, const char *name)
3595 /* If a target needs .got.plt section, relocations in rela.plt/rel.plt
3596 section likely apply to .got.plt or .got section. */
3597 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->want_got_plt
3598 && strcmp (name, ".plt") == 0)
3603 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, name);
3609 return bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, name);
3612 /* Return the section to which RELOC_SEC applies. */
3615 elf_get_reloc_section (asection *reloc_sec)
3620 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
3622 type = elf_section_data (reloc_sec)->this_hdr.sh_type;
3623 if (type != SHT_REL && type != SHT_RELA)
3626 /* We look up the section the relocs apply to by name. */
3627 name = reloc_sec->name;
3628 if (strncmp (name, ".rel", 4) != 0)
3631 if (type == SHT_RELA && *name++ != 'a')
3634 abfd = reloc_sec->owner;
3635 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3636 return bed->get_reloc_section (abfd, name);
3639 /* Assign all ELF section numbers. The dummy first section is handled here
3640 too. The link/info pointers for the standard section types are filled
3641 in here too, while we're at it. */
3644 assign_section_numbers (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
3646 struct elf_obj_tdata *t = elf_tdata (abfd);
3648 unsigned int section_number;
3649 Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrp;
3650 struct bfd_elf_section_data *d;
3651 bfd_boolean need_symtab;
3655 _bfd_elf_strtab_clear_all_refs (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
3657 /* SHT_GROUP sections are in relocatable files only. */
3658 if (link_info == NULL || !link_info->resolve_section_groups)
3660 size_t reloc_count = 0;
3662 /* Put SHT_GROUP sections first. */
3663 for (sec = abfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
3665 d = elf_section_data (sec);
3667 if (d->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_GROUP)
3669 if (sec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED)
3671 /* Remove the linker created SHT_GROUP sections. */
3672 bfd_section_list_remove (abfd, sec);
3673 abfd->section_count--;
3676 d->this_idx = section_number++;
3679 /* Count relocations. */
3680 reloc_count += sec->reloc_count;
3683 /* Clear HAS_RELOC if there are no relocations. */
3684 if (reloc_count == 0)
3685 abfd->flags &= ~HAS_RELOC;
3688 for (sec = abfd->sections; sec; sec = sec->next)
3690 d = elf_section_data (sec);
3692 if (d->this_hdr.sh_type != SHT_GROUP)
3693 d->this_idx = section_number++;
3694 if (d->this_hdr.sh_name != (unsigned int) -1)
3695 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), d->this_hdr.sh_name);
3698 d->rel.idx = section_number++;
3699 if (d->rel.hdr->sh_name != (unsigned int) -1)
3700 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), d->rel.hdr->sh_name);
3707 d->rela.idx = section_number++;
3708 if (d->rela.hdr->sh_name != (unsigned int) -1)
3709 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), d->rela.hdr->sh_name);
3715 need_symtab = (bfd_get_symcount (abfd) > 0
3716 || (link_info == NULL
3717 && ((abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC | HAS_RELOC))
3721 elf_onesymtab (abfd) = section_number++;
3722 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), t->symtab_hdr.sh_name);
3723 if (section_number > ((SHN_LORESERVE - 2) & 0xFFFF))
3725 elf_section_list * entry;
3727 BFD_ASSERT (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) == NULL);
3729 entry = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof * entry);
3730 entry->ndx = section_number++;
3731 elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) = entry;
3733 = (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd),
3734 ".symtab_shndx", FALSE);
3735 if (entry->hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
3738 elf_strtab_sec (abfd) = section_number++;
3739 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), t->strtab_hdr.sh_name);
3742 elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd) = section_number++;
3743 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), t->shstrtab_hdr.sh_name);
3744 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_shstrndx = elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd);
3746 if (section_number >= SHN_LORESERVE)
3748 /* xgettext:c-format */
3749 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: too many sections: %u"),
3750 abfd, section_number);
3754 elf_numsections (abfd) = section_number;
3755 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_shnum = section_number;
3757 /* Set up the list of section header pointers, in agreement with the
3759 i_shdrp = (Elf_Internal_Shdr **) bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, section_number,
3760 sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr *));
3761 if (i_shdrp == NULL)
3764 i_shdrp[0] = (Elf_Internal_Shdr *) bfd_zalloc (abfd,
3765 sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr));
3766 if (i_shdrp[0] == NULL)
3768 bfd_release (abfd, i_shdrp);
3772 elf_elfsections (abfd) = i_shdrp;
3774 i_shdrp[elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd)] = &t->shstrtab_hdr;
3777 i_shdrp[elf_onesymtab (abfd)] = &t->symtab_hdr;
3778 if (elf_numsections (abfd) > (SHN_LORESERVE & 0xFFFF))
3780 elf_section_list * entry = elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd);
3781 BFD_ASSERT (entry != NULL);
3782 i_shdrp[entry->ndx] = & entry->hdr;
3783 entry->hdr.sh_link = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
3785 i_shdrp[elf_strtab_sec (abfd)] = &t->strtab_hdr;
3786 t->symtab_hdr.sh_link = elf_strtab_sec (abfd);
3789 for (sec = abfd->sections; sec; sec = sec->next)
3793 d = elf_section_data (sec);
3795 i_shdrp[d->this_idx] = &d->this_hdr;
3796 if (d->rel.idx != 0)
3797 i_shdrp[d->rel.idx] = d->rel.hdr;
3798 if (d->rela.idx != 0)
3799 i_shdrp[d->rela.idx] = d->rela.hdr;
3801 /* Fill in the sh_link and sh_info fields while we're at it. */
3803 /* sh_link of a reloc section is the section index of the symbol
3804 table. sh_info is the section index of the section to which
3805 the relocation entries apply. */
3806 if (d->rel.idx != 0)
3808 d->rel.hdr->sh_link = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
3809 d->rel.hdr->sh_info = d->this_idx;
3810 d->rel.hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_INFO_LINK;
3812 if (d->rela.idx != 0)
3814 d->rela.hdr->sh_link = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
3815 d->rela.hdr->sh_info = d->this_idx;
3816 d->rela.hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_INFO_LINK;
3819 /* We need to set up sh_link for SHF_LINK_ORDER. */
3820 if ((d->this_hdr.sh_flags & SHF_LINK_ORDER) != 0)
3822 s = elf_linked_to_section (sec);
3825 /* elf_linked_to_section points to the input section. */
3826 if (link_info != NULL)
3828 /* Check discarded linkonce section. */
3829 if (discarded_section (s))
3833 /* xgettext:c-format */
3834 (_("%pB: sh_link of section `%pA' points to"
3835 " discarded section `%pA' of `%pB'"),
3836 abfd, d->this_hdr.bfd_section,
3838 /* Point to the kept section if it has the same
3839 size as the discarded one. */
3840 kept = _bfd_elf_check_kept_section (s, link_info);
3843 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3849 s = s->output_section;
3850 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
3854 /* Handle objcopy. */
3855 if (s->output_section == NULL)
3858 /* xgettext:c-format */
3859 (_("%pB: sh_link of section `%pA' points to"
3860 " removed section `%pA' of `%pB'"),
3861 abfd, d->this_hdr.bfd_section, s, s->owner);
3862 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3865 s = s->output_section;
3867 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3872 The Intel C compiler generates SHT_IA_64_UNWIND with
3873 SHF_LINK_ORDER. But it doesn't set the sh_link or
3874 sh_info fields. Hence we could get the situation
3876 const struct elf_backend_data *bed
3877 = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3878 if (bed->link_order_error_handler)
3879 bed->link_order_error_handler
3880 /* xgettext:c-format */
3881 (_("%pB: warning: sh_link not set for section `%pA'"),
3886 switch (d->this_hdr.sh_type)
3890 /* A reloc section which we are treating as a normal BFD
3891 section. sh_link is the section index of the symbol
3892 table. sh_info is the section index of the section to
3893 which the relocation entries apply. We assume that an
3894 allocated reloc section uses the dynamic symbol table.
3895 FIXME: How can we be sure? */
3896 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynsym");
3898 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3900 s = elf_get_reloc_section (sec);
3903 d->this_hdr.sh_info = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3904 d->this_hdr.sh_flags |= SHF_INFO_LINK;
3909 /* We assume that a section named .stab*str is a stabs
3910 string section. We look for a section with the same name
3911 but without the trailing ``str'', and set its sh_link
3912 field to point to this section. */
3913 if (CONST_STRNEQ (sec->name, ".stab")
3914 && strcmp (sec->name + strlen (sec->name) - 3, "str") == 0)
3919 len = strlen (sec->name);
3920 alc = (char *) bfd_malloc (len - 2);
3923 memcpy (alc, sec->name, len - 3);
3924 alc[len - 3] = '\0';
3925 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, alc);
3929 elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_link = d->this_idx;
3931 /* This is a .stab section. */
3932 if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize == 0)
3933 elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize
3934 = 4 + 2 * bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 8;
3941 case SHT_GNU_verneed:
3942 case SHT_GNU_verdef:
3943 /* sh_link is the section header index of the string table
3944 used for the dynamic entries, or the symbol table, or the
3946 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynstr");
3948 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3951 case SHT_GNU_LIBLIST:
3952 /* sh_link is the section header index of the prelink library
3953 list used for the dynamic entries, or the symbol table, or
3954 the version strings. */
3955 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, (sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC)
3956 ? ".dynstr" : ".gnu.libstr");
3958 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3963 case SHT_GNU_versym:
3964 /* sh_link is the section header index of the symbol table
3965 this hash table or version table is for. */
3966 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynsym");
3968 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3972 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
3976 /* Delay setting sh_name to _bfd_elf_write_object_contents so that
3977 _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load can convert DWARF
3978 debug section name from .debug_* to .zdebug_* if needed. */
3984 sym_is_global (bfd *abfd, asymbol *sym)
3986 /* If the backend has a special mapping, use it. */
3987 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3988 if (bed->elf_backend_sym_is_global)
3989 return (*bed->elf_backend_sym_is_global) (abfd, sym);
3991 return ((sym->flags & (BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_WEAK | BSF_GNU_UNIQUE)) != 0
3992 || bfd_is_und_section (bfd_get_section (sym))
3993 || bfd_is_com_section (bfd_get_section (sym)));
3996 /* Filter global symbols of ABFD to include in the import library. All
3997 SYMCOUNT symbols of ABFD can be examined from their pointers in
3998 SYMS. Pointers of symbols to keep should be stored contiguously at
3999 the beginning of that array.
4001 Returns the number of symbols to keep. */
4004 _bfd_elf_filter_global_symbols (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
4005 asymbol **syms, long symcount)
4007 long src_count, dst_count = 0;
4009 for (src_count = 0; src_count < symcount; src_count++)
4011 asymbol *sym = syms[src_count];
4012 char *name = (char *) bfd_asymbol_name (sym);
4013 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *h;
4015 if (!sym_is_global (abfd, sym))
4018 h = bfd_link_hash_lookup (info->hash, name, FALSE, FALSE, FALSE);
4021 if (h->type != bfd_link_hash_defined && h->type != bfd_link_hash_defweak)
4023 if (h->linker_def || h->ldscript_def)
4026 syms[dst_count++] = sym;
4029 syms[dst_count] = NULL;
4034 /* Don't output section symbols for sections that are not going to be
4035 output, that are duplicates or there is no BFD section. */
4038 ignore_section_sym (bfd *abfd, asymbol *sym)
4040 elf_symbol_type *type_ptr;
4045 if ((sym->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) == 0)
4048 if (sym->section == NULL)
4051 type_ptr = elf_symbol_from (abfd, sym);
4052 return ((type_ptr != NULL
4053 && type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx != 0
4054 && bfd_is_abs_section (sym->section))
4055 || !(sym->section->owner == abfd
4056 || (sym->section->output_section != NULL
4057 && sym->section->output_section->owner == abfd
4058 && sym->section->output_offset == 0)
4059 || bfd_is_abs_section (sym->section)));
4062 /* Map symbol from it's internal number to the external number, moving
4063 all local symbols to be at the head of the list. */
4066 elf_map_symbols (bfd *abfd, unsigned int *pnum_locals)
4068 unsigned int symcount = bfd_get_symcount (abfd);
4069 asymbol **syms = bfd_get_outsymbols (abfd);
4070 asymbol **sect_syms;
4071 unsigned int num_locals = 0;
4072 unsigned int num_globals = 0;
4073 unsigned int num_locals2 = 0;
4074 unsigned int num_globals2 = 0;
4075 unsigned int max_index = 0;
4081 fprintf (stderr, "elf_map_symbols\n");
4085 for (asect = abfd->sections; asect; asect = asect->next)
4087 if (max_index < asect->index)
4088 max_index = asect->index;
4092 sect_syms = (asymbol **) bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, max_index, sizeof (asymbol *));
4093 if (sect_syms == NULL)
4095 elf_section_syms (abfd) = sect_syms;
4096 elf_num_section_syms (abfd) = max_index;
4098 /* Init sect_syms entries for any section symbols we have already
4099 decided to output. */
4100 for (idx = 0; idx < symcount; idx++)
4102 asymbol *sym = syms[idx];
4104 if ((sym->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) != 0
4106 && !ignore_section_sym (abfd, sym)
4107 && !bfd_is_abs_section (sym->section))
4109 asection *sec = sym->section;
4111 if (sec->owner != abfd)
4112 sec = sec->output_section;
4114 sect_syms[sec->index] = syms[idx];
4118 /* Classify all of the symbols. */
4119 for (idx = 0; idx < symcount; idx++)
4121 if (sym_is_global (abfd, syms[idx]))
4123 else if (!ignore_section_sym (abfd, syms[idx]))
4127 /* We will be adding a section symbol for each normal BFD section. Most
4128 sections will already have a section symbol in outsymbols, but
4129 eg. SHT_GROUP sections will not, and we need the section symbol mapped
4130 at least in that case. */
4131 for (asect = abfd->sections; asect; asect = asect->next)
4133 if (sect_syms[asect->index] == NULL)
4135 if (!sym_is_global (abfd, asect->symbol))
4142 /* Now sort the symbols so the local symbols are first. */
4143 new_syms = (asymbol **) bfd_alloc2 (abfd, num_locals + num_globals,
4144 sizeof (asymbol *));
4146 if (new_syms == NULL)
4149 for (idx = 0; idx < symcount; idx++)
4151 asymbol *sym = syms[idx];
4154 if (sym_is_global (abfd, sym))
4155 i = num_locals + num_globals2++;
4156 else if (!ignore_section_sym (abfd, sym))
4161 sym->udata.i = i + 1;
4163 for (asect = abfd->sections; asect; asect = asect->next)
4165 if (sect_syms[asect->index] == NULL)
4167 asymbol *sym = asect->symbol;
4170 sect_syms[asect->index] = sym;
4171 if (!sym_is_global (abfd, sym))
4174 i = num_locals + num_globals2++;
4176 sym->udata.i = i + 1;
4180 bfd_set_symtab (abfd, new_syms, num_locals + num_globals);
4182 *pnum_locals = num_locals;
4186 /* Align to the maximum file alignment that could be required for any
4187 ELF data structure. */
4189 static inline file_ptr
4190 align_file_position (file_ptr off, int align)
4192 return (off + align - 1) & ~(align - 1);
4195 /* Assign a file position to a section, optionally aligning to the
4196 required section alignment. */
4199 _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (Elf_Internal_Shdr *i_shdrp,
4203 if (align && i_shdrp->sh_addralign > 1)
4204 offset = BFD_ALIGN (offset, i_shdrp->sh_addralign);
4205 i_shdrp->sh_offset = offset;
4206 if (i_shdrp->bfd_section != NULL)
4207 i_shdrp->bfd_section->filepos = offset;
4208 if (i_shdrp->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
4209 offset += i_shdrp->sh_size;
4213 /* Compute the file positions we are going to put the sections at, and
4214 otherwise prepare to begin writing out the ELF file. If LINK_INFO
4215 is not NULL, this is being called by the ELF backend linker. */
4218 _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions (bfd *abfd,
4219 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
4221 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
4222 struct fake_section_arg fsargs;
4224 struct elf_strtab_hash *strtab = NULL;
4225 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shstrtab_hdr;
4226 bfd_boolean need_symtab;
4228 if (abfd->output_has_begun)
4231 /* Do any elf backend specific processing first. */
4232 if (bed->elf_backend_begin_write_processing)
4233 (*bed->elf_backend_begin_write_processing) (abfd, link_info);
4235 if (! prep_headers (abfd))
4238 /* Post process the headers if necessary. */
4239 (*bed->elf_backend_post_process_headers) (abfd, link_info);
4241 fsargs.failed = FALSE;
4242 fsargs.link_info = link_info;
4243 bfd_map_over_sections (abfd, elf_fake_sections, &fsargs);
4247 if (!assign_section_numbers (abfd, link_info))
4250 /* The backend linker builds symbol table information itself. */
4251 need_symtab = (link_info == NULL
4252 && (bfd_get_symcount (abfd) > 0
4253 || ((abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC | HAS_RELOC))
4257 /* Non-zero if doing a relocatable link. */
4258 int relocatable_p = ! (abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC));
4260 if (! swap_out_syms (abfd, &strtab, relocatable_p))
4265 if (link_info == NULL)
4267 bfd_map_over_sections (abfd, bfd_elf_set_group_contents, &failed);
4272 shstrtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr;
4273 /* sh_name was set in prep_headers. */
4274 shstrtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_STRTAB;
4275 shstrtab_hdr->sh_flags = bed->elf_strtab_flags;
4276 shstrtab_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
4277 /* sh_size is set in _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load. */
4278 shstrtab_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
4279 shstrtab_hdr->sh_link = 0;
4280 shstrtab_hdr->sh_info = 0;
4281 /* sh_offset is set in _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load. */
4282 shstrtab_hdr->sh_addralign = 1;
4284 if (!assign_file_positions_except_relocs (abfd, link_info))
4290 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
4292 off = elf_next_file_pos (abfd);
4294 hdr = & elf_symtab_hdr (abfd);
4295 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
4297 if (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) != NULL)
4299 hdr = & elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd)->hdr;
4300 if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
4301 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
4302 /* FIXME: What about other symtab_shndx sections in the list ? */
4305 hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr;
4306 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
4308 elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
4310 /* Now that we know where the .strtab section goes, write it
4312 if (bfd_seek (abfd, hdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
4313 || ! _bfd_elf_strtab_emit (abfd, strtab))
4315 _bfd_elf_strtab_free (strtab);
4318 abfd->output_has_begun = TRUE;
4323 /* Make an initial estimate of the size of the program header. If we
4324 get the number wrong here, we'll redo section placement. */
4326 static bfd_size_type
4327 get_program_header_size (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
4331 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
4333 /* Assume we will need exactly two PT_LOAD segments: one for text
4334 and one for data. */
4337 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".interp");
4338 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0 && s->size != 0)
4340 /* If we have a loadable interpreter section, we need a
4341 PT_INTERP segment. In this case, assume we also need a
4342 PT_PHDR segment, although that may not be true for all
4347 if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic") != NULL)
4349 /* We need a PT_DYNAMIC segment. */
4353 if (info != NULL && info->relro)
4355 /* We need a PT_GNU_RELRO segment. */
4359 if (elf_eh_frame_hdr (abfd))
4361 /* We need a PT_GNU_EH_FRAME segment. */
4365 if (elf_stack_flags (abfd))
4367 /* We need a PT_GNU_STACK segment. */
4371 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
4373 if ((s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
4374 && elf_section_type (s) == SHT_NOTE)
4376 unsigned int alignment_power;
4377 /* We need a PT_NOTE segment. */
4379 /* Try to create just one PT_NOTE segment for all adjacent
4380 loadable SHT_NOTE sections. gABI requires that within a
4381 PT_NOTE segment (and also inside of each SHT_NOTE section)
4382 each note should have the same alignment. So we check
4383 whether the sections are correctly aligned. */
4384 alignment_power = s->alignment_power;
4385 while (s->next != NULL
4386 && s->next->alignment_power == alignment_power
4387 && (s->next->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
4388 && elf_section_type (s->next) == SHT_NOTE)
4393 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
4395 if (s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
4397 /* We need a PT_TLS segment. */
4403 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
4405 if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0)
4407 /* Add a PT_GNU_MBIND segment for each mbind section. */
4408 unsigned int page_align_power = bfd_log2 (bed->commonpagesize);
4409 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
4410 if (elf_section_flags (s) & SHF_GNU_MBIND)
4412 if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_info
4416 /* xgettext:c-format */
4417 (_("%pB: GNU_MBIN section `%pA' has invalid sh_info field: %d"),
4418 abfd, s, elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_info);
4421 /* Align mbind section to page size. */
4422 if (s->alignment_power < page_align_power)
4423 s->alignment_power = page_align_power;
4428 /* Let the backend count up any program headers it might need. */
4429 if (bed->elf_backend_additional_program_headers)
4433 a = (*bed->elf_backend_additional_program_headers) (abfd, info);
4439 return segs * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
4442 /* Find the segment that contains the output_section of section. */
4445 _bfd_elf_find_segment_containing_section (bfd * abfd, asection * section)
4447 struct elf_segment_map *m;
4448 Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
4450 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd), p = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
4456 for (i = m->count - 1; i >= 0; i--)
4457 if (m->sections[i] == section)
4464 /* Create a mapping from a set of sections to a program segment. */
4466 static struct elf_segment_map *
4467 make_mapping (bfd *abfd,
4468 asection **sections,
4473 struct elf_segment_map *m;
4478 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map) - sizeof (asection *);
4479 amt += (to - from) * sizeof (asection *);
4480 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4484 m->p_type = PT_LOAD;
4485 for (i = from, hdrpp = sections + from; i < to; i++, hdrpp++)
4486 m->sections[i - from] = *hdrpp;
4487 m->count = to - from;
4489 if (from == 0 && phdr)
4491 /* Include the headers in the first PT_LOAD segment. */
4492 m->includes_filehdr = 1;
4493 m->includes_phdrs = 1;
4499 /* Create the PT_DYNAMIC segment, which includes DYNSEC. Returns NULL
4502 struct elf_segment_map *
4503 _bfd_elf_make_dynamic_segment (bfd *abfd, asection *dynsec)
4505 struct elf_segment_map *m;
4507 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd,
4508 sizeof (struct elf_segment_map));
4512 m->p_type = PT_DYNAMIC;
4514 m->sections[0] = dynsec;
4519 /* Possibly add or remove segments from the segment map. */
4522 elf_modify_segment_map (bfd *abfd,
4523 struct bfd_link_info *info,
4524 bfd_boolean remove_empty_load)
4526 struct elf_segment_map **m;
4527 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
4529 /* The placement algorithm assumes that non allocated sections are
4530 not in PT_LOAD segments. We ensure this here by removing such
4531 sections from the segment map. We also remove excluded
4532 sections. Finally, any PT_LOAD segment without sections is
4534 m = &elf_seg_map (abfd);
4537 unsigned int i, new_count;
4539 for (new_count = 0, i = 0; i < (*m)->count; i++)
4541 if (((*m)->sections[i]->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) == 0
4542 && (((*m)->sections[i]->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
4543 || (*m)->p_type != PT_LOAD))
4545 (*m)->sections[new_count] = (*m)->sections[i];
4549 (*m)->count = new_count;
4551 if (remove_empty_load
4552 && (*m)->p_type == PT_LOAD
4554 && !(*m)->includes_phdrs)
4560 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
4561 if (bed->elf_backend_modify_segment_map != NULL)
4563 if (!(*bed->elf_backend_modify_segment_map) (abfd, info))
4570 #define IS_TBSS(s) \
4571 ((s->flags & (SEC_THREAD_LOCAL | SEC_LOAD)) == SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
4573 /* Set up a mapping from BFD sections to program segments. */
4576 _bfd_elf_map_sections_to_segments (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
4579 struct elf_segment_map *m;
4580 asection **sections = NULL;
4581 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
4582 bfd_boolean no_user_phdrs;
4584 no_user_phdrs = elf_seg_map (abfd) == NULL;
4587 info->user_phdrs = !no_user_phdrs;
4589 if (no_user_phdrs && bfd_count_sections (abfd) != 0)
4593 struct elf_segment_map *mfirst;
4594 struct elf_segment_map **pm;
4597 unsigned int hdr_index;
4598 bfd_vma maxpagesize;
4600 bfd_boolean phdr_in_segment = TRUE;
4601 bfd_boolean writable;
4602 bfd_boolean executable;
4604 asection *first_tls = NULL;
4605 asection *first_mbind = NULL;
4606 asection *dynsec, *eh_frame_hdr;
4608 bfd_vma addr_mask, wrap_to = 0;
4609 bfd_boolean linker_created_pt_phdr_segment = FALSE;
4611 /* Select the allocated sections, and sort them. */
4613 sections = (asection **) bfd_malloc2 (bfd_count_sections (abfd),
4614 sizeof (asection *));
4615 if (sections == NULL)
4618 /* Calculate top address, avoiding undefined behaviour of shift
4619 left operator when shift count is equal to size of type
4621 addr_mask = ((bfd_vma) 1 << (bfd_arch_bits_per_address (abfd) - 1)) - 1;
4622 addr_mask = (addr_mask << 1) + 1;
4625 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
4627 if ((s->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
4631 /* A wrapping section potentially clashes with header. */
4632 if (((s->lma + s->size) & addr_mask) < (s->lma & addr_mask))
4633 wrap_to = (s->lma + s->size) & addr_mask;
4636 BFD_ASSERT (i <= bfd_count_sections (abfd));
4639 qsort (sections, (size_t) count, sizeof (asection *), elf_sort_sections);
4641 /* Build the mapping. */
4646 /* If we have a .interp section, then create a PT_PHDR segment for
4647 the program headers and a PT_INTERP segment for the .interp
4649 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".interp");
4650 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0 && s->size != 0)
4652 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4653 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4657 m->p_type = PT_PHDR;
4659 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
4660 m->includes_phdrs = 1;
4661 linker_created_pt_phdr_segment = TRUE;
4665 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4666 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4670 m->p_type = PT_INTERP;
4678 /* Look through the sections. We put sections in the same program
4679 segment when the start of the second section can be placed within
4680 a few bytes of the end of the first section. */
4684 maxpagesize = bed->maxpagesize;
4685 /* PR 17512: file: c8455299.
4686 Avoid divide-by-zero errors later on.
4687 FIXME: Should we abort if the maxpagesize is zero ? */
4688 if (maxpagesize == 0)
4692 dynsec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
4694 && (dynsec->flags & SEC_LOAD) == 0)
4697 /* Deal with -Ttext or something similar such that the first section
4698 is not adjacent to the program headers. This is an
4699 approximation, since at this point we don't know exactly how many
4700 program headers we will need. */
4703 bfd_size_type phdr_size = elf_program_header_size (abfd);
4705 if (phdr_size == (bfd_size_type) -1)
4706 phdr_size = get_program_header_size (abfd, info);
4707 phdr_size += bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
4708 if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) == 0
4709 || (sections[0]->lma & addr_mask) < phdr_size
4710 || ((sections[0]->lma & addr_mask) % maxpagesize
4711 < phdr_size % maxpagesize)
4712 || (sections[0]->lma & addr_mask & -maxpagesize) < wrap_to)
4714 /* PR 20815: The ELF standard says that a PT_PHDR segment, if
4715 present, must be included as part of the memory image of the
4716 program. Ie it must be part of a PT_LOAD segment as well.
4717 If we have had to create our own PT_PHDR segment, but it is
4718 not going to be covered by the first PT_LOAD segment, then
4719 force the inclusion if we can... */
4720 if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0
4721 && linker_created_pt_phdr_segment)
4722 phdr_in_segment = TRUE;
4724 phdr_in_segment = FALSE;
4728 for (i = 0, hdrpp = sections; i < count; i++, hdrpp++)
4731 bfd_boolean new_segment;
4735 /* See if this section and the last one will fit in the same
4738 if (last_hdr == NULL)
4740 /* If we don't have a segment yet, then we don't need a new
4741 one (we build the last one after this loop). */
4742 new_segment = FALSE;
4744 else if (last_hdr->lma - last_hdr->vma != hdr->lma - hdr->vma)
4746 /* If this section has a different relation between the
4747 virtual address and the load address, then we need a new
4751 else if (hdr->lma < last_hdr->lma + last_size
4752 || last_hdr->lma + last_size < last_hdr->lma)
4754 /* If this section has a load address that makes it overlap
4755 the previous section, then we need a new segment. */
4758 else if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0
4759 && (((last_hdr->lma + last_size - 1) & -maxpagesize)
4760 == (hdr->lma & -maxpagesize)))
4762 /* If we are demand paged then we can't map two disk
4763 pages onto the same memory page. */
4764 new_segment = FALSE;
4766 /* In the next test we have to be careful when last_hdr->lma is close
4767 to the end of the address space. If the aligned address wraps
4768 around to the start of the address space, then there are no more
4769 pages left in memory and it is OK to assume that the current
4770 section can be included in the current segment. */
4771 else if ((BFD_ALIGN (last_hdr->lma + last_size, maxpagesize)
4772 + maxpagesize > last_hdr->lma)
4773 && (BFD_ALIGN (last_hdr->lma + last_size, maxpagesize)
4774 + maxpagesize <= hdr->lma))
4776 /* If putting this section in this segment would force us to
4777 skip a page in the segment, then we need a new segment. */
4780 else if ((last_hdr->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) == 0
4781 && (hdr->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) != 0)
4783 /* We don't want to put a loaded section after a
4784 nonloaded (ie. bss style) section in the same segment
4785 as that will force the non-loaded section to be loaded.
4786 Consider .tbss sections as loaded for this purpose. */
4789 else if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) == 0)
4791 /* If the file is not demand paged, which means that we
4792 don't require the sections to be correctly aligned in the
4793 file, then there is no other reason for a new segment. */
4794 new_segment = FALSE;
4796 else if (info != NULL
4797 && info->separate_code
4798 && executable != ((hdr->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0))
4803 && (hdr->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
4805 /* We don't want to put a writable section in a read only
4811 /* Otherwise, we can use the same segment. */
4812 new_segment = FALSE;
4815 /* Allow interested parties a chance to override our decision. */
4816 if (last_hdr != NULL
4818 && info->callbacks->override_segment_assignment != NULL)
4820 = info->callbacks->override_segment_assignment (info, abfd, hdr,
4826 if ((hdr->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
4828 if ((hdr->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
4831 /* .tbss sections effectively have zero size. */
4832 last_size = !IS_TBSS (hdr) ? hdr->size : 0;
4836 /* We need a new program segment. We must create a new program
4837 header holding all the sections from hdr_index until hdr. */
4839 m = make_mapping (abfd, sections, hdr_index, i, phdr_in_segment);
4846 if ((hdr->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
4851 if ((hdr->flags & SEC_CODE) == 0)
4857 /* .tbss sections effectively have zero size. */
4858 last_size = !IS_TBSS (hdr) ? hdr->size : 0;
4860 phdr_in_segment = FALSE;
4863 /* Create a final PT_LOAD program segment, but not if it's just
4865 if (last_hdr != NULL
4866 && (i - hdr_index != 1
4867 || !IS_TBSS (last_hdr)))
4869 m = make_mapping (abfd, sections, hdr_index, i, phdr_in_segment);
4877 /* If there is a .dynamic section, throw in a PT_DYNAMIC segment. */
4880 m = _bfd_elf_make_dynamic_segment (abfd, dynsec);
4887 /* For each batch of consecutive loadable SHT_NOTE sections,
4888 add a PT_NOTE segment. We don't use bfd_get_section_by_name,
4889 because if we link together nonloadable .note sections and
4890 loadable .note sections, we will generate two .note sections
4891 in the output file. */
4892 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
4894 if ((s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
4895 && elf_section_type (s) == SHT_NOTE)
4898 unsigned int alignment_power = s->alignment_power;
4901 for (s2 = s; s2->next != NULL; s2 = s2->next)
4903 if (s2->next->alignment_power == alignment_power
4904 && (s2->next->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
4905 && elf_section_type (s2->next) == SHT_NOTE
4906 && align_power (s2->lma + s2->size,
4913 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map) - sizeof (asection *);
4914 amt += count * sizeof (asection *);
4915 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4919 m->p_type = PT_NOTE;
4923 m->sections[m->count - count--] = s;
4924 BFD_ASSERT ((s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) == 0);
4927 m->sections[m->count - 1] = s;
4928 BFD_ASSERT ((s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) == 0);
4932 if (s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
4938 if (first_mbind == NULL
4939 && (elf_section_flags (s) & SHF_GNU_MBIND) != 0)
4943 /* If there are any SHF_TLS output sections, add PT_TLS segment. */
4946 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map) - sizeof (asection *);
4947 amt += tls_count * sizeof (asection *);
4948 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4953 m->count = tls_count;
4954 /* Mandated PF_R. */
4956 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
4958 for (i = 0; i < (unsigned int) tls_count; ++i)
4960 if ((s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) == 0)
4963 (_("%pB: TLS sections are not adjacent:"), abfd);
4966 while (i < (unsigned int) tls_count)
4968 if ((s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)
4970 _bfd_error_handler (_(" TLS: %pA"), s);
4974 _bfd_error_handler (_(" non-TLS: %pA"), s);
4977 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
4988 if (first_mbind && (abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0)
4989 for (s = first_mbind; s != NULL; s = s->next)
4990 if ((elf_section_flags (s) & SHF_GNU_MBIND) != 0
4991 && (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_info
4992 <= PT_GNU_MBIND_NUM))
4994 /* Mandated PF_R. */
4995 unsigned long p_flags = PF_R;
4996 if ((s->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
4998 if ((s->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
5001 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map) + sizeof (asection *);
5002 m = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5006 m->p_type = (PT_GNU_MBIND_LO
5007 + elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_info);
5009 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
5011 m->p_flags = p_flags;
5017 /* If there is a .eh_frame_hdr section, throw in a PT_GNU_EH_FRAME
5019 eh_frame_hdr = elf_eh_frame_hdr (abfd);
5020 if (eh_frame_hdr != NULL
5021 && (eh_frame_hdr->output_section->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
5023 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
5024 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5028 m->p_type = PT_GNU_EH_FRAME;
5030 m->sections[0] = eh_frame_hdr->output_section;
5036 if (elf_stack_flags (abfd))
5038 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
5039 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5043 m->p_type = PT_GNU_STACK;
5044 m->p_flags = elf_stack_flags (abfd);
5045 m->p_align = bed->stack_align;
5046 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
5047 m->p_align_valid = m->p_align != 0;
5048 if (info->stacksize > 0)
5050 m->p_size = info->stacksize;
5051 m->p_size_valid = 1;
5058 if (info != NULL && info->relro)
5060 for (m = mfirst; m != NULL; m = m->next)
5062 if (m->p_type == PT_LOAD
5064 && m->sections[0]->vma >= info->relro_start
5065 && m->sections[0]->vma < info->relro_end)
5068 while (--i != (unsigned) -1)
5069 if ((m->sections[i]->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS))
5070 == (SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS))
5073 if (i != (unsigned) -1)
5078 /* Make a PT_GNU_RELRO segment only when it isn't empty. */
5081 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
5082 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5086 m->p_type = PT_GNU_RELRO;
5093 elf_seg_map (abfd) = mfirst;
5096 if (!elf_modify_segment_map (abfd, info, no_user_phdrs))
5099 for (count = 0, m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
5101 elf_program_header_size (abfd) = count * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5106 if (sections != NULL)
5111 /* Sort sections by address. */
5114 elf_sort_sections (const void *arg1, const void *arg2)
5116 const asection *sec1 = *(const asection **) arg1;
5117 const asection *sec2 = *(const asection **) arg2;
5118 bfd_size_type size1, size2;
5120 /* Sort by LMA first, since this is the address used to
5121 place the section into a segment. */
5122 if (sec1->lma < sec2->lma)
5124 else if (sec1->lma > sec2->lma)
5127 /* Then sort by VMA. Normally the LMA and the VMA will be
5128 the same, and this will do nothing. */
5129 if (sec1->vma < sec2->vma)
5131 else if (sec1->vma > sec2->vma)
5134 /* Put !SEC_LOAD sections after SEC_LOAD ones. */
5136 #define TOEND(x) (((x)->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) == 0)
5142 /* If the indices are the same, do not return 0
5143 here, but continue to try the next comparison. */
5144 if (sec1->target_index - sec2->target_index != 0)
5145 return sec1->target_index - sec2->target_index;
5150 else if (TOEND (sec2))
5155 /* Sort by size, to put zero sized sections
5156 before others at the same address. */
5158 size1 = (sec1->flags & SEC_LOAD) ? sec1->size : 0;
5159 size2 = (sec2->flags & SEC_LOAD) ? sec2->size : 0;
5166 return sec1->target_index - sec2->target_index;
5169 /* Ian Lance Taylor writes:
5171 We shouldn't be using % with a negative signed number. That's just
5172 not good. We have to make sure either that the number is not
5173 negative, or that the number has an unsigned type. When the types
5174 are all the same size they wind up as unsigned. When file_ptr is a
5175 larger signed type, the arithmetic winds up as signed long long,
5178 What we're trying to say here is something like ``increase OFF by
5179 the least amount that will cause it to be equal to the VMA modulo
5181 /* In other words, something like:
5183 vma_offset = m->sections[0]->vma % bed->maxpagesize;
5184 off_offset = off % bed->maxpagesize;
5185 if (vma_offset < off_offset)
5186 adjustment = vma_offset + bed->maxpagesize - off_offset;
5188 adjustment = vma_offset - off_offset;
5190 which can be collapsed into the expression below. */
5193 vma_page_aligned_bias (bfd_vma vma, ufile_ptr off, bfd_vma maxpagesize)
5195 /* PR binutils/16199: Handle an alignment of zero. */
5196 if (maxpagesize == 0)
5198 return ((vma - off) % maxpagesize);
5202 print_segment_map (const struct elf_segment_map *m)
5205 const char *pt = get_segment_type (m->p_type);
5210 if (m->p_type >= PT_LOPROC && m->p_type <= PT_HIPROC)
5211 sprintf (buf, "LOPROC+%7.7x",
5212 (unsigned int) (m->p_type - PT_LOPROC));
5213 else if (m->p_type >= PT_LOOS && m->p_type <= PT_HIOS)
5214 sprintf (buf, "LOOS+%7.7x",
5215 (unsigned int) (m->p_type - PT_LOOS));
5217 snprintf (buf, sizeof (buf), "%8.8x",
5218 (unsigned int) m->p_type);
5222 fprintf (stderr, "%s:", pt);
5223 for (j = 0; j < m->count; j++)
5224 fprintf (stderr, " %s", m->sections [j]->name);
5230 write_zeros (bfd *abfd, file_ptr pos, bfd_size_type len)
5235 if (bfd_seek (abfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0)
5237 buf = bfd_zmalloc (len);
5240 ret = bfd_bwrite (buf, len, abfd) == len;
5245 /* Assign file positions to the sections based on the mapping from
5246 sections to segments. This function also sets up some fields in
5250 assign_file_positions_for_load_sections (bfd *abfd,
5251 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
5253 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
5254 struct elf_segment_map *m;
5255 Elf_Internal_Phdr *phdrs;
5256 Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
5258 bfd_size_type maxpagesize;
5259 unsigned int pt_load_count = 0;
5262 bfd_vma header_pad = 0;
5264 if (link_info == NULL
5265 && !_bfd_elf_map_sections_to_segments (abfd, link_info))
5269 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
5273 header_pad = m->header_size;
5278 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phoff = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5279 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phentsize = bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5283 /* PR binutils/12467. */
5284 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phoff = 0;
5285 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phentsize = 0;
5288 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum = alloc;
5290 if (elf_program_header_size (abfd) == (bfd_size_type) -1)
5291 elf_program_header_size (abfd) = alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5293 BFD_ASSERT (elf_program_header_size (abfd)
5294 >= alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr);
5298 elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5302 /* We're writing the size in elf_program_header_size (abfd),
5303 see assign_file_positions_except_relocs, so make sure we have
5304 that amount allocated, with trailing space cleared.
5305 The variable alloc contains the computed need, while
5306 elf_program_header_size (abfd) contains the size used for the
5308 See ld/emultempl/elf-generic.em:gld${EMULATION_NAME}_map_segments
5309 where the layout is forced to according to a larger size in the
5310 last iterations for the testcase ld-elf/header. */
5311 BFD_ASSERT (elf_program_header_size (abfd) % bed->s->sizeof_phdr
5313 phdrs = (Elf_Internal_Phdr *)
5315 (elf_program_header_size (abfd) / bed->s->sizeof_phdr),
5316 sizeof (Elf_Internal_Phdr));
5317 elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr = phdrs;
5322 if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0)
5323 maxpagesize = bed->maxpagesize;
5325 off = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5326 off += alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5327 if (header_pad < (bfd_vma) off)
5333 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd), p = phdrs, j = 0;
5335 m = m->next, p++, j++)
5339 bfd_boolean no_contents;
5341 /* If elf_segment_map is not from map_sections_to_segments, the
5342 sections may not be correctly ordered. NOTE: sorting should
5343 not be done to the PT_NOTE section of a corefile, which may
5344 contain several pseudo-sections artificially created by bfd.
5345 Sorting these pseudo-sections breaks things badly. */
5347 && !(elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_type == ET_CORE
5348 && m->p_type == PT_NOTE))
5349 qsort (m->sections, (size_t) m->count, sizeof (asection *),
5352 /* An ELF segment (described by Elf_Internal_Phdr) may contain a
5353 number of sections with contents contributing to both p_filesz
5354 and p_memsz, followed by a number of sections with no contents
5355 that just contribute to p_memsz. In this loop, OFF tracks next
5356 available file offset for PT_LOAD and PT_NOTE segments. */
5357 p->p_type = m->p_type;
5358 p->p_flags = m->p_flags;
5363 p->p_vaddr = m->sections[0]->vma - m->p_vaddr_offset;
5365 if (m->p_paddr_valid)
5366 p->p_paddr = m->p_paddr;
5367 else if (m->count == 0)
5370 p->p_paddr = m->sections[0]->lma - m->p_vaddr_offset;
5372 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD
5373 && (abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0)
5375 /* p_align in demand paged PT_LOAD segments effectively stores
5376 the maximum page size. When copying an executable with
5377 objcopy, we set m->p_align from the input file. Use this
5378 value for maxpagesize rather than bed->maxpagesize, which
5379 may be different. Note that we use maxpagesize for PT_TLS
5380 segment alignment later in this function, so we are relying
5381 on at least one PT_LOAD segment appearing before a PT_TLS
5383 if (m->p_align_valid)
5384 maxpagesize = m->p_align;
5386 p->p_align = maxpagesize;
5389 else if (m->p_align_valid)
5390 p->p_align = m->p_align;
5391 else if (m->count == 0)
5392 p->p_align = 1 << bed->s->log_file_align;
5396 no_contents = FALSE;
5398 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD
5401 bfd_size_type align;
5402 unsigned int align_power = 0;
5404 if (m->p_align_valid)
5408 for (i = 0, secpp = m->sections; i < m->count; i++, secpp++)
5410 unsigned int secalign;
5412 secalign = bfd_get_section_alignment (abfd, *secpp);
5413 if (secalign > align_power)
5414 align_power = secalign;
5416 align = (bfd_size_type) 1 << align_power;
5417 if (align < maxpagesize)
5418 align = maxpagesize;
5421 for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
5422 if ((m->sections[i]->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS)) == 0)
5423 /* If we aren't making room for this section, then
5424 it must be SHT_NOBITS regardless of what we've
5425 set via struct bfd_elf_special_section. */
5426 elf_section_type (m->sections[i]) = SHT_NOBITS;
5428 /* Find out whether this segment contains any loadable
5431 for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
5432 if (elf_section_type (m->sections[i]) != SHT_NOBITS)
5434 no_contents = FALSE;
5438 off_adjust = vma_page_aligned_bias (p->p_vaddr, off, align);
5440 /* Broken hardware and/or kernel require that files do not
5441 map the same page with different permissions on some hppa
5443 if (pt_load_count > 1
5444 && bed->no_page_alias
5445 && (off & (maxpagesize - 1)) != 0
5446 && (off & -maxpagesize) == ((off + off_adjust) & -maxpagesize))
5447 off_adjust += maxpagesize;
5451 /* We shouldn't need to align the segment on disk since
5452 the segment doesn't need file space, but the gABI
5453 arguably requires the alignment and glibc ld.so
5454 checks it. So to comply with the alignment
5455 requirement but not waste file space, we adjust
5456 p_offset for just this segment. (OFF_ADJUST is
5457 subtracted from OFF later.) This may put p_offset
5458 past the end of file, but that shouldn't matter. */
5463 /* Make sure the .dynamic section is the first section in the
5464 PT_DYNAMIC segment. */
5465 else if (p->p_type == PT_DYNAMIC
5467 && strcmp (m->sections[0]->name, ".dynamic") != 0)
5470 (_("%pB: The first section in the PT_DYNAMIC segment"
5471 " is not the .dynamic section"),
5473 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
5476 /* Set the note section type to SHT_NOTE. */
5477 else if (p->p_type == PT_NOTE)
5478 for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
5479 elf_section_type (m->sections[i]) = SHT_NOTE;
5485 if (m->includes_filehdr)
5487 if (!m->p_flags_valid)
5489 p->p_filesz = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5490 p->p_memsz = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5493 if (p->p_vaddr < (bfd_vma) off
5494 || (!m->p_paddr_valid
5495 && p->p_paddr < (bfd_vma) off))
5498 (_("%pB: not enough room for program headers,"
5499 " try linking with -N"),
5501 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
5506 if (!m->p_paddr_valid)
5511 if (m->includes_phdrs)
5513 if (!m->p_flags_valid)
5516 if (!m->includes_filehdr)
5518 p->p_offset = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5522 p->p_vaddr -= off - p->p_offset;
5523 if (!m->p_paddr_valid)
5524 p->p_paddr -= off - p->p_offset;
5528 p->p_filesz += alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5529 p->p_memsz += alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5532 p->p_filesz += header_pad;
5533 p->p_memsz += header_pad;
5537 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD
5538 || (p->p_type == PT_NOTE && bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core))
5540 if (!m->includes_filehdr && !m->includes_phdrs)
5546 adjust = off - (p->p_offset + p->p_filesz);
5548 p->p_filesz += adjust;
5549 p->p_memsz += adjust;
5553 /* Set up p_filesz, p_memsz, p_align and p_flags from the section
5554 maps. Set filepos for sections in PT_LOAD segments, and in
5555 core files, for sections in PT_NOTE segments.
5556 assign_file_positions_for_non_load_sections will set filepos
5557 for other sections and update p_filesz for other segments. */
5558 for (i = 0, secpp = m->sections; i < m->count; i++, secpp++)
5561 bfd_size_type align;
5562 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
5565 this_hdr = &elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr;
5566 align = (bfd_size_type) 1 << bfd_get_section_alignment (abfd, sec);
5568 if ((p->p_type == PT_LOAD
5569 || p->p_type == PT_TLS)
5570 && (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS
5571 || ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0
5572 && ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) == 0
5573 || p->p_type == PT_TLS))))
5575 bfd_vma p_start = p->p_paddr;
5576 bfd_vma p_end = p_start + p->p_memsz;
5577 bfd_vma s_start = sec->lma;
5578 bfd_vma adjust = s_start - p_end;
5582 || p_end < p_start))
5585 /* xgettext:c-format */
5586 (_("%pB: section %pA lma %#" PRIx64 " adjusted to %#" PRIx64),
5587 abfd, sec, (uint64_t) s_start, (uint64_t) p_end);
5591 p->p_memsz += adjust;
5593 if (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
5595 if (p->p_filesz + adjust < p->p_memsz)
5597 /* We have a PROGBITS section following NOBITS ones.
5598 Allocate file space for the NOBITS section(s) and
5600 adjust = p->p_memsz - p->p_filesz;
5601 if (!write_zeros (abfd, off, adjust))
5605 p->p_filesz += adjust;
5609 if (p->p_type == PT_NOTE && bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core)
5611 /* The section at i == 0 is the one that actually contains
5615 this_hdr->sh_offset = sec->filepos = off;
5616 off += this_hdr->sh_size;
5617 p->p_filesz = this_hdr->sh_size;
5623 /* The rest are fake sections that shouldn't be written. */
5632 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD)
5634 this_hdr->sh_offset = sec->filepos = off;
5635 if (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
5636 off += this_hdr->sh_size;
5638 else if (this_hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS
5639 && (this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) != 0
5640 && this_hdr->sh_offset == 0)
5642 /* This is a .tbss section that didn't get a PT_LOAD.
5643 (See _bfd_elf_map_sections_to_segments "Create a
5644 final PT_LOAD".) Set sh_offset to the value it
5645 would have if we had created a zero p_filesz and
5646 p_memsz PT_LOAD header for the section. This
5647 also makes the PT_TLS header have the same
5649 bfd_vma adjust = vma_page_aligned_bias (this_hdr->sh_addr,
5651 this_hdr->sh_offset = sec->filepos = off + adjust;
5654 if (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
5656 p->p_filesz += this_hdr->sh_size;
5657 /* A load section without SHF_ALLOC is something like
5658 a note section in a PT_NOTE segment. These take
5659 file space but are not loaded into memory. */
5660 if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
5661 p->p_memsz += this_hdr->sh_size;
5663 else if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
5665 if (p->p_type == PT_TLS)
5666 p->p_memsz += this_hdr->sh_size;
5668 /* .tbss is special. It doesn't contribute to p_memsz of
5670 else if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) == 0)
5671 p->p_memsz += this_hdr->sh_size;
5674 if (align > p->p_align
5675 && !m->p_align_valid
5676 && (p->p_type != PT_LOAD
5677 || (abfd->flags & D_PAGED) == 0))
5681 if (!m->p_flags_valid)
5684 if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXECINSTR) != 0)
5686 if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_WRITE) != 0)
5693 /* Check that all sections are in a PT_LOAD segment.
5694 Don't check funky gdb generated core files. */
5695 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD && bfd_get_format (abfd) != bfd_core)
5697 bfd_boolean check_vma = TRUE;
5699 for (i = 1; i < m->count; i++)
5700 if (m->sections[i]->vma == m->sections[i - 1]->vma
5701 && ELF_SECTION_SIZE (&(elf_section_data (m->sections[i])
5702 ->this_hdr), p) != 0
5703 && ELF_SECTION_SIZE (&(elf_section_data (m->sections[i - 1])
5704 ->this_hdr), p) != 0)
5706 /* Looks like we have overlays packed into the segment. */
5711 for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
5713 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
5716 sec = m->sections[i];
5717 this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(sec)->this_hdr);
5718 if (!ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT_1 (this_hdr, p, check_vma, 0)
5719 && !ELF_TBSS_SPECIAL (this_hdr, p))
5722 /* xgettext:c-format */
5723 (_("%pB: section `%pA' can't be allocated in segment %d"),
5725 print_segment_map (m);
5731 elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
5735 /* Assign file positions for the other sections. */
5738 assign_file_positions_for_non_load_sections (bfd *abfd,
5739 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
5741 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
5742 Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrpp;
5743 Elf_Internal_Shdr **hdrpp, **end_hdrpp;
5744 Elf_Internal_Phdr *phdrs;
5745 Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
5746 struct elf_segment_map *m;
5747 struct elf_segment_map *hdrs_segment;
5748 bfd_vma filehdr_vaddr, filehdr_paddr;
5749 bfd_vma phdrs_vaddr, phdrs_paddr;
5753 i_shdrpp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
5754 end_hdrpp = i_shdrpp + elf_numsections (abfd);
5755 off = elf_next_file_pos (abfd);
5756 for (hdrpp = i_shdrpp + 1; hdrpp < end_hdrpp; hdrpp++)
5758 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
5761 if (hdr->bfd_section != NULL
5762 && (hdr->bfd_section->filepos != 0
5763 || (hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS
5764 && hdr->contents == NULL)))
5765 BFD_ASSERT (hdr->sh_offset == hdr->bfd_section->filepos);
5766 else if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
5768 if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
5770 /* xgettext:c-format */
5771 (_("%pB: warning: allocated section `%s' not in segment"),
5773 (hdr->bfd_section == NULL
5775 : hdr->bfd_section->name));
5776 /* We don't need to page align empty sections. */
5777 if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0 && hdr->sh_size != 0)
5778 off += vma_page_aligned_bias (hdr->sh_addr, off,
5781 off += vma_page_aligned_bias (hdr->sh_addr, off,
5783 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off,
5786 else if (((hdr->sh_type == SHT_REL || hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
5787 && hdr->bfd_section == NULL)
5788 || (hdr->bfd_section != NULL
5789 && (hdr->bfd_section->flags & SEC_ELF_COMPRESS))
5790 /* Compress DWARF debug sections. */
5791 || hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_onesymtab (abfd)]
5792 || (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) != NULL
5793 && hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd)->ndx])
5794 || hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_strtab_sec (abfd)]
5795 || hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd)])
5796 hdr->sh_offset = -1;
5798 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
5801 /* Now that we have set the section file positions, we can set up
5802 the file positions for the non PT_LOAD segments. */
5806 phdrs_vaddr = bed->maxpagesize + bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5808 hdrs_segment = NULL;
5809 phdrs = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
5810 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd), p = phdrs; m != NULL; m = m->next, p++)
5813 if (p->p_type != PT_LOAD)
5816 if (m->includes_filehdr)
5818 filehdr_vaddr = p->p_vaddr;
5819 filehdr_paddr = p->p_paddr;
5821 if (m->includes_phdrs)
5823 phdrs_vaddr = p->p_vaddr;
5824 phdrs_paddr = p->p_paddr;
5825 if (m->includes_filehdr)
5828 phdrs_vaddr += bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5829 phdrs_paddr += bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5834 if (hdrs_segment != NULL && link_info != NULL)
5836 /* There is a segment that contains both the file headers and the
5837 program headers, so provide a symbol __ehdr_start pointing there.
5838 A program can use this to examine itself robustly. */
5840 struct elf_link_hash_entry *hash
5841 = elf_link_hash_lookup (elf_hash_table (link_info), "__ehdr_start",
5842 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
5843 /* If the symbol was referenced and not defined, define it. */
5845 && (hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new
5846 || hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
5847 || hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
5848 || hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_common))
5851 if (hdrs_segment->count != 0)
5852 /* The segment contains sections, so use the first one. */
5853 s = hdrs_segment->sections[0];
5855 /* Use the first (i.e. lowest-addressed) section in any segment. */
5856 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
5865 hash->root.u.def.value = filehdr_vaddr - s->vma;
5866 hash->root.u.def.section = s;
5870 hash->root.u.def.value = filehdr_vaddr;
5871 hash->root.u.def.section = bfd_abs_section_ptr;
5874 hash->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
5875 hash->def_regular = 1;
5880 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd), p = phdrs; m != NULL; m = m->next, p++)
5882 if (p->p_type == PT_GNU_RELRO)
5887 if (link_info != NULL)
5889 /* During linking the range of the RELRO segment is passed
5890 in link_info. Note that there may be padding between
5891 relro_start and the first RELRO section. */
5892 start = link_info->relro_start;
5893 end = link_info->relro_end;
5895 else if (m->count != 0)
5897 if (!m->p_size_valid)
5899 start = m->sections[0]->vma;
5900 end = start + m->p_size;
5911 struct elf_segment_map *lm;
5912 const Elf_Internal_Phdr *lp;
5915 /* Find a LOAD segment containing a section in the RELRO
5917 for (lm = elf_seg_map (abfd), lp = phdrs;
5919 lm = lm->next, lp++)
5921 if (lp->p_type == PT_LOAD
5923 && (lm->sections[lm->count - 1]->vma
5924 + (!IS_TBSS (lm->sections[lm->count - 1])
5925 ? lm->sections[lm->count - 1]->size
5927 && lm->sections[0]->vma < end)
5933 /* Find the section starting the RELRO segment. */
5934 for (i = 0; i < lm->count; i++)
5936 asection *s = lm->sections[i];
5945 p->p_vaddr = lm->sections[i]->vma;
5946 p->p_paddr = lm->sections[i]->lma;
5947 p->p_offset = lm->sections[i]->filepos;
5948 p->p_memsz = end - p->p_vaddr;
5949 p->p_filesz = p->p_memsz;
5951 /* The RELRO segment typically ends a few bytes
5952 into .got.plt but other layouts are possible.
5953 In cases where the end does not match any
5954 loaded section (for instance is in file
5955 padding), trim p_filesz back to correspond to
5956 the end of loaded section contents. */
5957 if (p->p_filesz > lp->p_vaddr + lp->p_filesz - p->p_vaddr)
5958 p->p_filesz = lp->p_vaddr + lp->p_filesz - p->p_vaddr;
5960 /* Preserve the alignment and flags if they are
5961 valid. The gold linker generates RW/4 for
5962 the PT_GNU_RELRO section. It is better for
5963 objcopy/strip to honor these attributes
5964 otherwise gdb will choke when using separate
5966 if (!m->p_align_valid)
5968 if (!m->p_flags_valid)
5974 if (link_info != NULL)
5977 memset (p, 0, sizeof *p);
5979 else if (p->p_type == PT_GNU_STACK)
5981 if (m->p_size_valid)
5982 p->p_memsz = m->p_size;
5984 else if (m->count != 0)
5988 if (p->p_type != PT_LOAD
5989 && (p->p_type != PT_NOTE
5990 || bfd_get_format (abfd) != bfd_core))
5992 /* A user specified segment layout may include a PHDR
5993 segment that overlaps with a LOAD segment... */
5994 if (p->p_type == PT_PHDR)
6000 if (m->includes_filehdr || m->includes_phdrs)
6002 /* PR 17512: file: 2195325e. */
6004 (_("%pB: error: non-load segment %d includes file header "
6005 "and/or program header"),
6006 abfd, (int) (p - phdrs));
6011 p->p_offset = m->sections[0]->filepos;
6012 for (i = m->count; i-- != 0;)
6014 asection *sect = m->sections[i];
6015 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr = &elf_section_data (sect)->this_hdr;
6016 if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
6018 p->p_filesz = (sect->filepos - m->sections[0]->filepos
6025 else if (m->includes_filehdr)
6027 p->p_vaddr = filehdr_vaddr;
6028 if (! m->p_paddr_valid)
6029 p->p_paddr = filehdr_paddr;
6031 else if (m->includes_phdrs)
6033 p->p_vaddr = phdrs_vaddr;
6034 if (! m->p_paddr_valid)
6035 p->p_paddr = phdrs_paddr;
6039 elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
6044 static elf_section_list *
6045 find_section_in_list (unsigned int i, elf_section_list * list)
6047 for (;list != NULL; list = list->next)
6053 /* Work out the file positions of all the sections. This is called by
6054 _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions. All the section sizes and
6055 VMAs must be known before this is called.
6057 Reloc sections come in two flavours: Those processed specially as
6058 "side-channel" data attached to a section to which they apply, and
6059 those that bfd doesn't process as relocations. The latter sort are
6060 stored in a normal bfd section by bfd_section_from_shdr. We don't
6061 consider the former sort here, unless they form part of the loadable
6062 image. Reloc sections not assigned here will be handled later by
6063 assign_file_positions_for_relocs.
6065 We also don't set the positions of the .symtab and .strtab here. */
6068 assign_file_positions_except_relocs (bfd *abfd,
6069 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
6071 struct elf_obj_tdata *tdata = elf_tdata (abfd);
6072 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
6073 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6075 if ((abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC)) == 0
6076 && bfd_get_format (abfd) != bfd_core)
6078 Elf_Internal_Shdr ** const i_shdrpp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
6079 unsigned int num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
6080 Elf_Internal_Shdr **hdrpp;
6084 /* Start after the ELF header. */
6085 off = i_ehdrp->e_ehsize;
6087 /* We are not creating an executable, which means that we are
6088 not creating a program header, and that the actual order of
6089 the sections in the file is unimportant. */
6090 for (i = 1, hdrpp = i_shdrpp + 1; i < num_sec; i++, hdrpp++)
6092 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
6095 if (((hdr->sh_type == SHT_REL || hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
6096 && hdr->bfd_section == NULL)
6097 || (hdr->bfd_section != NULL
6098 && (hdr->bfd_section->flags & SEC_ELF_COMPRESS))
6099 /* Compress DWARF debug sections. */
6100 || i == elf_onesymtab (abfd)
6101 || (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) != NULL
6102 && hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd)->ndx])
6103 || i == elf_strtab_sec (abfd)
6104 || i == elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd))
6106 hdr->sh_offset = -1;
6109 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
6112 elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
6118 /* Assign file positions for the loaded sections based on the
6119 assignment of sections to segments. */
6120 if (!assign_file_positions_for_load_sections (abfd, link_info))
6123 /* And for non-load sections. */
6124 if (!assign_file_positions_for_non_load_sections (abfd, link_info))
6127 if (bed->elf_backend_modify_program_headers != NULL)
6129 if (!(*bed->elf_backend_modify_program_headers) (abfd, link_info))
6133 /* Set e_type in ELF header to ET_EXEC for -pie -Ttext-segment=. */
6134 if (link_info != NULL && bfd_link_pie (link_info))
6136 unsigned int num_segments = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum;
6137 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
6138 Elf_Internal_Phdr *end_segment = &segment[num_segments];
6140 /* Find the lowest p_vaddr in PT_LOAD segments. */
6141 bfd_vma p_vaddr = (bfd_vma) -1;
6142 for (; segment < end_segment; segment++)
6143 if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD && p_vaddr > segment->p_vaddr)
6144 p_vaddr = segment->p_vaddr;
6146 /* Set e_type to ET_EXEC if the lowest p_vaddr in PT_LOAD
6147 segments is non-zero. */
6149 i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_EXEC;
6152 /* Write out the program headers. */
6153 alloc = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum;
6157 /* PR ld/20815 - Check that the program header segment, if present, will
6158 be loaded into memory. FIXME: The check below is not sufficient as
6159 really all PT_LOAD segments should be checked before issuing an error
6160 message. Plus the PHDR segment does not have to be the first segment
6161 in the program header table. But this version of the check should
6162 catch all real world use cases.
6164 FIXME: We used to have code here to sort the PT_LOAD segments into
6165 ascending order, as per the ELF spec. But this breaks some programs,
6166 including the Linux kernel. But really either the spec should be
6167 changed or the programs updated. */
6169 && tdata->phdr[0].p_type == PT_PHDR
6170 && (bed->elf_backend_allow_non_load_phdr == NULL
6171 || !bed->elf_backend_allow_non_load_phdr (abfd, tdata->phdr,
6173 && tdata->phdr[1].p_type == PT_LOAD
6174 && (tdata->phdr[1].p_vaddr > tdata->phdr[0].p_vaddr
6175 || (tdata->phdr[1].p_vaddr + tdata->phdr[1].p_memsz
6176 < tdata->phdr[0].p_vaddr + tdata->phdr[0].p_memsz)))
6178 /* The fix for this error is usually to edit the linker script being
6179 used and set up the program headers manually. Either that or
6180 leave room for the headers at the start of the SECTIONS. */
6181 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: error: PHDR segment not covered"
6182 " by LOAD segment"),
6187 if (bfd_seek (abfd, (bfd_signed_vma) bed->s->sizeof_ehdr, SEEK_SET) != 0
6188 || bed->s->write_out_phdrs (abfd, tdata->phdr, alloc) != 0)
6196 prep_headers (bfd *abfd)
6198 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdrp; /* Elf file header, internal form. */
6199 struct elf_strtab_hash *shstrtab;
6200 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6202 i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
6204 shstrtab = _bfd_elf_strtab_init ();
6205 if (shstrtab == NULL)
6208 elf_shstrtab (abfd) = shstrtab;
6210 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG0] = ELFMAG0;
6211 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG1] = ELFMAG1;
6212 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG2] = ELFMAG2;
6213 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG3] = ELFMAG3;
6215 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_CLASS] = bed->s->elfclass;
6216 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_DATA] =
6217 bfd_big_endian (abfd) ? ELFDATA2MSB : ELFDATA2LSB;
6218 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_VERSION] = bed->s->ev_current;
6220 if ((abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0)
6221 i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_DYN;
6222 else if ((abfd->flags & EXEC_P) != 0)
6223 i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_EXEC;
6224 else if (bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core)
6225 i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_CORE;
6227 i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_REL;
6229 switch (bfd_get_arch (abfd))
6231 case bfd_arch_unknown:
6232 i_ehdrp->e_machine = EM_NONE;
6235 /* There used to be a long list of cases here, each one setting
6236 e_machine to the same EM_* macro #defined as ELF_MACHINE_CODE
6237 in the corresponding bfd definition. To avoid duplication,
6238 the switch was removed. Machines that need special handling
6239 can generally do it in elf_backend_final_write_processing(),
6240 unless they need the information earlier than the final write.
6241 Such need can generally be supplied by replacing the tests for
6242 e_machine with the conditions used to determine it. */
6244 i_ehdrp->e_machine = bed->elf_machine_code;
6247 i_ehdrp->e_version = bed->s->ev_current;
6248 i_ehdrp->e_ehsize = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
6250 /* No program header, for now. */
6251 i_ehdrp->e_phoff = 0;
6252 i_ehdrp->e_phentsize = 0;
6253 i_ehdrp->e_phnum = 0;
6255 /* Each bfd section is section header entry. */
6256 i_ehdrp->e_entry = bfd_get_start_address (abfd);
6257 i_ehdrp->e_shentsize = bed->s->sizeof_shdr;
6259 /* If we're building an executable, we'll need a program header table. */
6260 if (abfd->flags & EXEC_P)
6261 /* It all happens later. */
6265 i_ehdrp->e_phentsize = 0;
6266 i_ehdrp->e_phoff = 0;
6269 elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr.sh_name =
6270 (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (shstrtab, ".symtab", FALSE);
6271 elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr.sh_name =
6272 (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (shstrtab, ".strtab", FALSE);
6273 elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr.sh_name =
6274 (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (shstrtab, ".shstrtab", FALSE);
6275 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1
6276 || elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1
6277 || elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
6283 /* Assign file positions for all the reloc sections which are not part
6284 of the loadable file image, and the file position of section headers. */
6287 _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load (bfd *abfd)
6290 Elf_Internal_Shdr **shdrpp, **end_shdrpp;
6291 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdrp;
6292 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdrp;
6293 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
6295 off = elf_next_file_pos (abfd);
6297 shdrpp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
6298 end_shdrpp = shdrpp + elf_numsections (abfd);
6299 for (shdrpp++; shdrpp < end_shdrpp; shdrpp++)
6302 if (shdrp->sh_offset == -1)
6304 asection *sec = shdrp->bfd_section;
6305 bfd_boolean is_rel = (shdrp->sh_type == SHT_REL
6306 || shdrp->sh_type == SHT_RELA);
6308 || (sec != NULL && (sec->flags & SEC_ELF_COMPRESS)))
6312 const char *name = sec->name;
6313 struct bfd_elf_section_data *d;
6315 /* Compress DWARF debug sections. */
6316 if (!bfd_compress_section (abfd, sec,
6320 if (sec->compress_status == COMPRESS_SECTION_DONE
6321 && (abfd->flags & BFD_COMPRESS_GABI) == 0)
6323 /* If section is compressed with zlib-gnu, convert
6324 section name from .debug_* to .zdebug_*. */
6326 = convert_debug_to_zdebug (abfd, name);
6327 if (new_name == NULL)
6331 /* Add section name to section name section. */
6332 if (shdrp->sh_name != (unsigned int) -1)
6335 = (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd),
6337 d = elf_section_data (sec);
6339 /* Add reloc section name to section name section. */
6341 && !_bfd_elf_set_reloc_sh_name (abfd,
6346 && !_bfd_elf_set_reloc_sh_name (abfd,
6351 /* Update section size and contents. */
6352 shdrp->sh_size = sec->size;
6353 shdrp->contents = sec->contents;
6354 shdrp->bfd_section->contents = NULL;
6356 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (shdrp,
6363 /* Place section name section after DWARF debug sections have been
6365 _bfd_elf_strtab_finalize (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
6366 shdrp = &elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr;
6367 shdrp->sh_size = _bfd_elf_strtab_size (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
6368 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (shdrp, off, TRUE);
6370 /* Place the section headers. */
6371 i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
6372 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6373 off = align_file_position (off, 1 << bed->s->log_file_align);
6374 i_ehdrp->e_shoff = off;
6375 off += i_ehdrp->e_shnum * i_ehdrp->e_shentsize;
6376 elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
6382 _bfd_elf_write_object_contents (bfd *abfd)
6384 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6385 Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrp;
6387 unsigned int count, num_sec;
6388 struct elf_obj_tdata *t;
6390 if (! abfd->output_has_begun
6391 && ! _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions (abfd, NULL))
6393 /* Do not rewrite ELF data when the BFD has been opened for update.
6394 abfd->output_has_begun was set to TRUE on opening, so creation of new
6395 sections, and modification of existing section sizes was restricted.
6396 This means the ELF header, program headers and section headers can't have
6398 If the contents of any sections has been modified, then those changes have
6399 already been written to the BFD. */
6400 else if (abfd->direction == both_direction)
6402 BFD_ASSERT (abfd->output_has_begun);
6406 i_shdrp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
6409 bfd_map_over_sections (abfd, bed->s->write_relocs, &failed);
6413 if (!_bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load (abfd))
6416 /* After writing the headers, we need to write the sections too... */
6417 num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
6418 for (count = 1; count < num_sec; count++)
6420 i_shdrp[count]->sh_name
6421 = _bfd_elf_strtab_offset (elf_shstrtab (abfd),
6422 i_shdrp[count]->sh_name);
6423 if (bed->elf_backend_section_processing)
6424 if (!(*bed->elf_backend_section_processing) (abfd, i_shdrp[count]))
6426 if (i_shdrp[count]->contents)
6428 bfd_size_type amt = i_shdrp[count]->sh_size;
6430 if (bfd_seek (abfd, i_shdrp[count]->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
6431 || bfd_bwrite (i_shdrp[count]->contents, amt, abfd) != amt)
6436 /* Write out the section header names. */
6437 t = elf_tdata (abfd);
6438 if (elf_shstrtab (abfd) != NULL
6439 && (bfd_seek (abfd, t->shstrtab_hdr.sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
6440 || !_bfd_elf_strtab_emit (abfd, elf_shstrtab (abfd))))
6443 if (bed->elf_backend_final_write_processing)
6444 (*bed->elf_backend_final_write_processing) (abfd, elf_linker (abfd));
6446 if (!bed->s->write_shdrs_and_ehdr (abfd))
6449 /* This is last since write_shdrs_and_ehdr can touch i_shdrp[0]. */
6450 if (t->o->build_id.after_write_object_contents != NULL)
6451 return (*t->o->build_id.after_write_object_contents) (abfd);
6457 _bfd_elf_write_corefile_contents (bfd *abfd)
6459 /* Hopefully this can be done just like an object file. */
6460 return _bfd_elf_write_object_contents (abfd);
6463 /* Given a section, search the header to find them. */
6466 _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_section *asect)
6468 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
6469 unsigned int sec_index;
6471 if (elf_section_data (asect) != NULL
6472 && elf_section_data (asect)->this_idx != 0)
6473 return elf_section_data (asect)->this_idx;
6475 if (bfd_is_abs_section (asect))
6476 sec_index = SHN_ABS;
6477 else if (bfd_is_com_section (asect))
6478 sec_index = SHN_COMMON;
6479 else if (bfd_is_und_section (asect))
6480 sec_index = SHN_UNDEF;
6482 sec_index = SHN_BAD;
6484 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6485 if (bed->elf_backend_section_from_bfd_section)
6487 int retval = sec_index;
6489 if ((*bed->elf_backend_section_from_bfd_section) (abfd, asect, &retval))
6493 if (sec_index == SHN_BAD)
6494 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_nonrepresentable_section);
6499 /* Given a BFD symbol, return the index in the ELF symbol table, or -1
6503 _bfd_elf_symbol_from_bfd_symbol (bfd *abfd, asymbol **asym_ptr_ptr)
6505 asymbol *asym_ptr = *asym_ptr_ptr;
6507 flagword flags = asym_ptr->flags;
6509 /* When gas creates relocations against local labels, it creates its
6510 own symbol for the section, but does put the symbol into the
6511 symbol chain, so udata is 0. When the linker is generating
6512 relocatable output, this section symbol may be for one of the
6513 input sections rather than the output section. */
6514 if (asym_ptr->udata.i == 0
6515 && (flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM)
6516 && asym_ptr->section)
6521 sec = asym_ptr->section;
6522 if (sec->owner != abfd && sec->output_section != NULL)
6523 sec = sec->output_section;
6524 if (sec->owner == abfd
6525 && (indx = sec->index) < elf_num_section_syms (abfd)
6526 && elf_section_syms (abfd)[indx] != NULL)
6527 asym_ptr->udata.i = elf_section_syms (abfd)[indx]->udata.i;
6530 idx = asym_ptr->udata.i;
6534 /* This case can occur when using --strip-symbol on a symbol
6535 which is used in a relocation entry. */
6537 /* xgettext:c-format */
6538 (_("%pB: symbol `%s' required but not present"),
6539 abfd, bfd_asymbol_name (asym_ptr));
6540 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_no_symbols);
6547 "elf_symbol_from_bfd_symbol 0x%.8lx, name = %s, sym num = %d, flags = 0x%.8x\n",
6548 (long) asym_ptr, asym_ptr->name, idx, flags);
6556 /* Rewrite program header information. */
6559 rewrite_elf_program_header (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
6561 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *iehdr;
6562 struct elf_segment_map *map;
6563 struct elf_segment_map *map_first;
6564 struct elf_segment_map **pointer_to_map;
6565 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment;
6568 unsigned int num_segments;
6569 bfd_boolean phdr_included = FALSE;
6570 bfd_boolean p_paddr_valid;
6571 bfd_vma maxpagesize;
6572 struct elf_segment_map *phdr_adjust_seg = NULL;
6573 unsigned int phdr_adjust_num = 0;
6574 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
6576 bed = get_elf_backend_data (ibfd);
6577 iehdr = elf_elfheader (ibfd);
6580 pointer_to_map = &map_first;
6582 num_segments = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_phnum;
6583 maxpagesize = get_elf_backend_data (obfd)->maxpagesize;
6585 /* Returns the end address of the segment + 1. */
6586 #define SEGMENT_END(segment, start) \
6587 (start + (segment->p_memsz > segment->p_filesz \
6588 ? segment->p_memsz : segment->p_filesz))
6590 #define SECTION_SIZE(section, segment) \
6591 (((section->flags & (SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) \
6592 != SEC_THREAD_LOCAL || segment->p_type == PT_TLS) \
6593 ? section->size : 0)
6595 /* Returns TRUE if the given section is contained within
6596 the given segment. VMA addresses are compared. */
6597 #define IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA(section, segment) \
6598 (section->vma >= segment->p_vaddr \
6599 && (section->vma + SECTION_SIZE (section, segment) \
6600 <= (SEGMENT_END (segment, segment->p_vaddr))))
6602 /* Returns TRUE if the given section is contained within
6603 the given segment. LMA addresses are compared. */
6604 #define IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA(section, segment, base) \
6605 (section->lma >= base \
6606 && (section->lma + SECTION_SIZE (section, segment) \
6607 <= SEGMENT_END (segment, base)))
6609 /* Handle PT_NOTE segment. */
6610 #define IS_NOTE(p, s) \
6611 (p->p_type == PT_NOTE \
6612 && elf_section_type (s) == SHT_NOTE \
6613 && (bfd_vma) s->filepos >= p->p_offset \
6614 && ((bfd_vma) s->filepos + s->size \
6615 <= p->p_offset + p->p_filesz))
6617 /* Special case: corefile "NOTE" section containing regs, prpsinfo
6619 #define IS_COREFILE_NOTE(p, s) \
6621 && bfd_get_format (ibfd) == bfd_core \
6625 /* The complicated case when p_vaddr is 0 is to handle the Solaris
6626 linker, which generates a PT_INTERP section with p_vaddr and
6627 p_memsz set to 0. */
6628 #define IS_SOLARIS_PT_INTERP(p, s) \
6630 && p->p_paddr == 0 \
6631 && p->p_memsz == 0 \
6632 && p->p_filesz > 0 \
6633 && (s->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) != 0 \
6635 && (bfd_vma) s->filepos >= p->p_offset \
6636 && ((bfd_vma) s->filepos + s->size \
6637 <= p->p_offset + p->p_filesz))
6639 /* Decide if the given section should be included in the given segment.
6640 A section will be included if:
6641 1. It is within the address space of the segment -- we use the LMA
6642 if that is set for the segment and the VMA otherwise,
6643 2. It is an allocated section or a NOTE section in a PT_NOTE
6645 3. There is an output section associated with it,
6646 4. The section has not already been allocated to a previous segment.
6647 5. PT_GNU_STACK segments do not include any sections.
6648 6. PT_TLS segment includes only SHF_TLS sections.
6649 7. SHF_TLS sections are only in PT_TLS or PT_LOAD segments.
6650 8. PT_DYNAMIC should not contain empty sections at the beginning
6651 (with the possible exception of .dynamic). */
6652 #define IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT(section, segment, bed) \
6653 ((((segment->p_paddr \
6654 ? IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA (section, segment, segment->p_paddr) \
6655 : IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA (section, segment)) \
6656 && (section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0) \
6657 || IS_NOTE (segment, section)) \
6658 && segment->p_type != PT_GNU_STACK \
6659 && (segment->p_type != PT_TLS \
6660 || (section->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) \
6661 && (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD \
6662 || segment->p_type == PT_TLS \
6663 || (section->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) == 0) \
6664 && (segment->p_type != PT_DYNAMIC \
6665 || SECTION_SIZE (section, segment) > 0 \
6666 || (segment->p_paddr \
6667 ? segment->p_paddr != section->lma \
6668 : segment->p_vaddr != section->vma) \
6669 || (strcmp (bfd_get_section_name (ibfd, section), ".dynamic") \
6671 && (segment->p_type != PT_LOAD || !section->segment_mark))
6673 /* If the output section of a section in the input segment is NULL,
6674 it is removed from the corresponding output segment. */
6675 #define INCLUDE_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT(section, segment, bed) \
6676 (IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT (section, segment, bed) \
6677 && section->output_section != NULL)
6679 /* Returns TRUE iff seg1 starts after the end of seg2. */
6680 #define SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT(seg1, seg2, field) \
6681 (seg1->field >= SEGMENT_END (seg2, seg2->field))
6683 /* Returns TRUE iff seg1 and seg2 overlap. Segments overlap iff both
6684 their VMA address ranges and their LMA address ranges overlap.
6685 It is possible to have overlapping VMA ranges without overlapping LMA
6686 ranges. RedBoot images for example can have both .data and .bss mapped
6687 to the same VMA range, but with the .data section mapped to a different
6689 #define SEGMENT_OVERLAPS(seg1, seg2) \
6690 ( !(SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg1, seg2, p_vaddr) \
6691 || SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg2, seg1, p_vaddr)) \
6692 && !(SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg1, seg2, p_paddr) \
6693 || SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg2, seg1, p_paddr)))
6695 /* Initialise the segment mark field. */
6696 for (section = ibfd->sections; section != NULL; section = section->next)
6697 section->segment_mark = FALSE;
6699 /* The Solaris linker creates program headers in which all the
6700 p_paddr fields are zero. When we try to objcopy or strip such a
6701 file, we get confused. Check for this case, and if we find it
6702 don't set the p_paddr_valid fields. */
6703 p_paddr_valid = FALSE;
6704 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
6707 if (segment->p_paddr != 0)
6709 p_paddr_valid = TRUE;
6713 /* Scan through the segments specified in the program header
6714 of the input BFD. For this first scan we look for overlaps
6715 in the loadable segments. These can be created by weird
6716 parameters to objcopy. Also, fix some solaris weirdness. */
6717 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
6722 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment2;
6724 if (segment->p_type == PT_INTERP)
6725 for (section = ibfd->sections; section; section = section->next)
6726 if (IS_SOLARIS_PT_INTERP (segment, section))
6728 /* Mininal change so that the normal section to segment
6729 assignment code will work. */
6730 segment->p_vaddr = section->vma;
6734 if (segment->p_type != PT_LOAD)
6736 /* Remove PT_GNU_RELRO segment. */
6737 if (segment->p_type == PT_GNU_RELRO)
6738 segment->p_type = PT_NULL;
6742 /* Determine if this segment overlaps any previous segments. */
6743 for (j = 0, segment2 = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr; j < i; j++, segment2++)
6745 bfd_signed_vma extra_length;
6747 if (segment2->p_type != PT_LOAD
6748 || !SEGMENT_OVERLAPS (segment, segment2))
6751 /* Merge the two segments together. */
6752 if (segment2->p_vaddr < segment->p_vaddr)
6754 /* Extend SEGMENT2 to include SEGMENT and then delete
6756 extra_length = (SEGMENT_END (segment, segment->p_vaddr)
6757 - SEGMENT_END (segment2, segment2->p_vaddr));
6759 if (extra_length > 0)
6761 segment2->p_memsz += extra_length;
6762 segment2->p_filesz += extra_length;
6765 segment->p_type = PT_NULL;
6767 /* Since we have deleted P we must restart the outer loop. */
6769 segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
6774 /* Extend SEGMENT to include SEGMENT2 and then delete
6776 extra_length = (SEGMENT_END (segment2, segment2->p_vaddr)
6777 - SEGMENT_END (segment, segment->p_vaddr));
6779 if (extra_length > 0)
6781 segment->p_memsz += extra_length;
6782 segment->p_filesz += extra_length;
6785 segment2->p_type = PT_NULL;
6790 /* The second scan attempts to assign sections to segments. */
6791 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
6795 unsigned int section_count;
6796 asection **sections;
6797 asection *output_section;
6799 asection *matching_lma;
6800 asection *suggested_lma;
6803 asection *first_section;
6805 if (segment->p_type == PT_NULL)
6808 first_section = NULL;
6809 /* Compute how many sections might be placed into this segment. */
6810 for (section = ibfd->sections, section_count = 0;
6812 section = section->next)
6814 /* Find the first section in the input segment, which may be
6815 removed from the corresponding output segment. */
6816 if (IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT (section, segment, bed))
6818 if (first_section == NULL)
6819 first_section = section;
6820 if (section->output_section != NULL)
6825 /* Allocate a segment map big enough to contain
6826 all of the sections we have selected. */
6827 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map) - sizeof (asection *);
6828 amt += (bfd_size_type) section_count * sizeof (asection *);
6829 map = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (obfd, amt);
6833 /* Initialise the fields of the segment map. Default to
6834 using the physical address of the segment in the input BFD. */
6836 map->p_type = segment->p_type;
6837 map->p_flags = segment->p_flags;
6838 map->p_flags_valid = 1;
6840 /* If the first section in the input segment is removed, there is
6841 no need to preserve segment physical address in the corresponding
6843 if (!first_section || first_section->output_section != NULL)
6845 map->p_paddr = segment->p_paddr;
6846 map->p_paddr_valid = p_paddr_valid;
6849 /* Determine if this segment contains the ELF file header
6850 and if it contains the program headers themselves. */
6851 map->includes_filehdr = (segment->p_offset == 0
6852 && segment->p_filesz >= iehdr->e_ehsize);
6853 map->includes_phdrs = 0;
6855 if (!phdr_included || segment->p_type != PT_LOAD)
6857 map->includes_phdrs =
6858 (segment->p_offset <= (bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
6859 && (segment->p_offset + segment->p_filesz
6860 >= ((bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
6861 + iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize)));
6863 if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD && map->includes_phdrs)
6864 phdr_included = TRUE;
6867 if (section_count == 0)
6869 /* Special segments, such as the PT_PHDR segment, may contain
6870 no sections, but ordinary, loadable segments should contain
6871 something. They are allowed by the ELF spec however, so only
6872 a warning is produced.
6873 There is however the valid use case of embedded systems which
6874 have segments with p_filesz of 0 and a p_memsz > 0 to initialize
6875 flash memory with zeros. No warning is shown for that case. */
6876 if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD
6877 && (segment->p_filesz > 0 || segment->p_memsz == 0))
6878 /* xgettext:c-format */
6880 (_("%pB: warning: empty loadable segment detected"
6881 " at vaddr=%#" PRIx64 ", is this intentional?"),
6882 ibfd, (uint64_t) segment->p_vaddr);
6885 *pointer_to_map = map;
6886 pointer_to_map = &map->next;
6891 /* Now scan the sections in the input BFD again and attempt
6892 to add their corresponding output sections to the segment map.
6893 The problem here is how to handle an output section which has
6894 been moved (ie had its LMA changed). There are four possibilities:
6896 1. None of the sections have been moved.
6897 In this case we can continue to use the segment LMA from the
6900 2. All of the sections have been moved by the same amount.
6901 In this case we can change the segment's LMA to match the LMA
6902 of the first section.
6904 3. Some of the sections have been moved, others have not.
6905 In this case those sections which have not been moved can be
6906 placed in the current segment which will have to have its size,
6907 and possibly its LMA changed, and a new segment or segments will
6908 have to be created to contain the other sections.
6910 4. The sections have been moved, but not by the same amount.
6911 In this case we can change the segment's LMA to match the LMA
6912 of the first section and we will have to create a new segment
6913 or segments to contain the other sections.
6915 In order to save time, we allocate an array to hold the section
6916 pointers that we are interested in. As these sections get assigned
6917 to a segment, they are removed from this array. */
6919 sections = (asection **) bfd_malloc2 (section_count, sizeof (asection *));
6920 if (sections == NULL)
6923 /* Step One: Scan for segment vs section LMA conflicts.
6924 Also add the sections to the section array allocated above.
6925 Also add the sections to the current segment. In the common
6926 case, where the sections have not been moved, this means that
6927 we have completely filled the segment, and there is nothing
6930 matching_lma = NULL;
6931 suggested_lma = NULL;
6933 for (section = first_section, j = 0;
6935 section = section->next)
6937 if (INCLUDE_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (section, segment, bed))
6939 output_section = section->output_section;
6941 sections[j++] = section;
6943 /* The Solaris native linker always sets p_paddr to 0.
6944 We try to catch that case here, and set it to the
6945 correct value. Note - some backends require that
6946 p_paddr be left as zero. */
6948 && segment->p_vaddr != 0
6949 && !bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero
6951 && output_section->lma != 0
6952 && (align_power (segment->p_vaddr
6953 + (map->includes_filehdr
6954 ? iehdr->e_ehsize : 0)
6955 + (map->includes_phdrs
6956 ? iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize
6958 output_section->alignment_power)
6959 == output_section->vma))
6960 map->p_paddr = segment->p_vaddr;
6962 /* Match up the physical address of the segment with the
6963 LMA address of the output section. */
6964 if (IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA (output_section, segment, map->p_paddr)
6965 || IS_COREFILE_NOTE (segment, section)
6966 || (bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero
6967 && IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA (output_section, segment)))
6969 if (matching_lma == NULL
6970 || output_section->lma < matching_lma->lma)
6971 matching_lma = output_section;
6973 /* We assume that if the section fits within the segment
6974 then it does not overlap any other section within that
6976 map->sections[isec++] = output_section;
6978 else if (suggested_lma == NULL)
6979 suggested_lma = output_section;
6981 if (j == section_count)
6986 BFD_ASSERT (j == section_count);
6988 /* Step Two: Adjust the physical address of the current segment,
6990 if (isec == section_count)
6992 /* All of the sections fitted within the segment as currently
6993 specified. This is the default case. Add the segment to
6994 the list of built segments and carry on to process the next
6995 program header in the input BFD. */
6996 map->count = section_count;
6997 *pointer_to_map = map;
6998 pointer_to_map = &map->next;
7001 && !bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero
7002 && matching_lma->lma != map->p_paddr
7003 && !map->includes_filehdr
7004 && !map->includes_phdrs)
7005 /* There is some padding before the first section in the
7006 segment. So, we must account for that in the output
7008 map->p_vaddr_offset = matching_lma->lma - map->p_paddr;
7015 /* Change the current segment's physical address to match
7016 the LMA of the first section that fitted, or if no
7017 section fitted, the first section. */
7018 if (matching_lma == NULL)
7019 matching_lma = suggested_lma;
7021 map->p_paddr = matching_lma->lma;
7023 /* Offset the segment physical address from the lma
7024 to allow for space taken up by elf headers. */
7025 if (map->includes_phdrs)
7027 map->p_paddr -= iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize;
7029 /* iehdr->e_phnum is just an estimate of the number
7030 of program headers that we will need. Make a note
7031 here of the number we used and the segment we chose
7032 to hold these headers, so that we can adjust the
7033 offset when we know the correct value. */
7034 phdr_adjust_num = iehdr->e_phnum;
7035 phdr_adjust_seg = map;
7038 if (map->includes_filehdr)
7040 bfd_vma align = (bfd_vma) 1 << matching_lma->alignment_power;
7041 map->p_paddr -= iehdr->e_ehsize;
7042 /* We've subtracted off the size of headers from the
7043 first section lma, but there may have been some
7044 alignment padding before that section too. Try to
7045 account for that by adjusting the segment lma down to
7046 the same alignment. */
7047 if (segment->p_align != 0 && segment->p_align < align)
7048 align = segment->p_align;
7049 map->p_paddr &= -align;
7053 /* Step Three: Loop over the sections again, this time assigning
7054 those that fit to the current segment and removing them from the
7055 sections array; but making sure not to leave large gaps. Once all
7056 possible sections have been assigned to the current segment it is
7057 added to the list of built segments and if sections still remain
7058 to be assigned, a new segment is constructed before repeating
7064 suggested_lma = NULL;
7066 /* Fill the current segment with sections that fit. */
7067 for (j = 0; j < section_count; j++)
7069 section = sections[j];
7071 if (section == NULL)
7074 output_section = section->output_section;
7076 BFD_ASSERT (output_section != NULL);
7078 if (IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA (output_section, segment, map->p_paddr)
7079 || IS_COREFILE_NOTE (segment, section))
7081 if (map->count == 0)
7083 /* If the first section in a segment does not start at
7084 the beginning of the segment, then something is
7086 if (align_power (map->p_paddr
7087 + (map->includes_filehdr
7088 ? iehdr->e_ehsize : 0)
7089 + (map->includes_phdrs
7090 ? iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize
7092 output_section->alignment_power)
7093 != output_section->lma)
7100 prev_sec = map->sections[map->count - 1];
7102 /* If the gap between the end of the previous section
7103 and the start of this section is more than
7104 maxpagesize then we need to start a new segment. */
7105 if ((BFD_ALIGN (prev_sec->lma + prev_sec->size,
7107 < BFD_ALIGN (output_section->lma, maxpagesize))
7108 || (prev_sec->lma + prev_sec->size
7109 > output_section->lma))
7111 if (suggested_lma == NULL)
7112 suggested_lma = output_section;
7118 map->sections[map->count++] = output_section;
7121 if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD)
7122 section->segment_mark = TRUE;
7124 else if (suggested_lma == NULL)
7125 suggested_lma = output_section;
7128 BFD_ASSERT (map->count > 0);
7130 /* Add the current segment to the list of built segments. */
7131 *pointer_to_map = map;
7132 pointer_to_map = &map->next;
7134 if (isec < section_count)
7136 /* We still have not allocated all of the sections to
7137 segments. Create a new segment here, initialise it
7138 and carry on looping. */
7139 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map) - sizeof (asection *);
7140 amt += (bfd_size_type) section_count * sizeof (asection *);
7141 map = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (obfd, amt);
7148 /* Initialise the fields of the segment map. Set the physical
7149 physical address to the LMA of the first section that has
7150 not yet been assigned. */
7152 map->p_type = segment->p_type;
7153 map->p_flags = segment->p_flags;
7154 map->p_flags_valid = 1;
7155 map->p_paddr = suggested_lma->lma;
7156 map->p_paddr_valid = p_paddr_valid;
7157 map->includes_filehdr = 0;
7158 map->includes_phdrs = 0;
7161 while (isec < section_count);
7166 elf_seg_map (obfd) = map_first;
7168 /* If we had to estimate the number of program headers that were
7169 going to be needed, then check our estimate now and adjust
7170 the offset if necessary. */
7171 if (phdr_adjust_seg != NULL)
7175 for (count = 0, map = map_first; map != NULL; map = map->next)
7178 if (count > phdr_adjust_num)
7179 phdr_adjust_seg->p_paddr
7180 -= (count - phdr_adjust_num) * iehdr->e_phentsize;
7182 for (map = map_first; map != NULL; map = map->next)
7183 if (map->p_type == PT_PHDR)
7186 = phdr_adjust_seg->includes_filehdr ? iehdr->e_ehsize : 0;
7187 map->p_paddr = phdr_adjust_seg->p_paddr + adjust;
7194 #undef IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA
7195 #undef IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA
7197 #undef IS_COREFILE_NOTE
7198 #undef IS_SOLARIS_PT_INTERP
7199 #undef IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT
7200 #undef INCLUDE_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT
7201 #undef SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT
7202 #undef SEGMENT_OVERLAPS
7206 /* Copy ELF program header information. */
7209 copy_elf_program_header (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
7211 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *iehdr;
7212 struct elf_segment_map *map;
7213 struct elf_segment_map *map_first;
7214 struct elf_segment_map **pointer_to_map;
7215 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment;
7217 unsigned int num_segments;
7218 bfd_boolean phdr_included = FALSE;
7219 bfd_boolean p_paddr_valid;
7221 iehdr = elf_elfheader (ibfd);
7224 pointer_to_map = &map_first;
7226 /* If all the segment p_paddr fields are zero, don't set
7227 map->p_paddr_valid. */
7228 p_paddr_valid = FALSE;
7229 num_segments = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_phnum;
7230 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
7233 if (segment->p_paddr != 0)
7235 p_paddr_valid = TRUE;
7239 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
7244 unsigned int section_count;
7246 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
7247 asection *first_section = NULL;
7248 asection *lowest_section;
7249 bfd_boolean no_contents = TRUE;
7251 /* Compute how many sections are in this segment. */
7252 for (section = ibfd->sections, section_count = 0;
7254 section = section->next)
7256 this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(section)->this_hdr);
7257 if (ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (this_hdr, segment))
7259 if (first_section == NULL)
7260 first_section = section;
7261 if (elf_section_type (section) != SHT_NOBITS)
7262 no_contents = FALSE;
7267 /* Allocate a segment map big enough to contain
7268 all of the sections we have selected. */
7269 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map) - sizeof (asection *);
7270 amt += (bfd_size_type) section_count * sizeof (asection *);
7271 map = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (obfd, amt);
7275 /* Initialize the fields of the output segment map with the
7278 map->p_type = segment->p_type;
7279 map->p_flags = segment->p_flags;
7280 map->p_flags_valid = 1;
7281 map->p_paddr = segment->p_paddr;
7282 map->p_paddr_valid = p_paddr_valid;
7283 map->p_align = segment->p_align;
7284 map->p_align_valid = 1;
7285 map->p_vaddr_offset = 0;
7287 if (map->p_type == PT_GNU_RELRO
7288 || map->p_type == PT_GNU_STACK)
7290 /* The PT_GNU_RELRO segment may contain the first a few
7291 bytes in the .got.plt section even if the whole .got.plt
7292 section isn't in the PT_GNU_RELRO segment. We won't
7293 change the size of the PT_GNU_RELRO segment.
7294 Similarly, PT_GNU_STACK size is significant on uclinux
7296 map->p_size = segment->p_memsz;
7297 map->p_size_valid = 1;
7300 /* Determine if this segment contains the ELF file header
7301 and if it contains the program headers themselves. */
7302 map->includes_filehdr = (segment->p_offset == 0
7303 && segment->p_filesz >= iehdr->e_ehsize);
7305 map->includes_phdrs = 0;
7306 if (! phdr_included || segment->p_type != PT_LOAD)
7308 map->includes_phdrs =
7309 (segment->p_offset <= (bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
7310 && (segment->p_offset + segment->p_filesz
7311 >= ((bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
7312 + iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize)));
7314 if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD && map->includes_phdrs)
7315 phdr_included = TRUE;
7318 lowest_section = NULL;
7319 if (section_count != 0)
7321 unsigned int isec = 0;
7323 for (section = first_section;
7325 section = section->next)
7327 this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(section)->this_hdr);
7328 if (ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (this_hdr, segment))
7330 map->sections[isec++] = section->output_section;
7331 if ((section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
7335 if (lowest_section == NULL
7336 || section->lma < lowest_section->lma)
7337 lowest_section = section;
7339 /* Section lmas are set up from PT_LOAD header
7340 p_paddr in _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr.
7341 If this header has a p_paddr that disagrees
7342 with the section lma, flag the p_paddr as
7344 if ((section->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
7345 seg_off = this_hdr->sh_offset - segment->p_offset;
7347 seg_off = this_hdr->sh_addr - segment->p_vaddr;
7348 if (section->lma - segment->p_paddr != seg_off)
7349 map->p_paddr_valid = FALSE;
7351 if (isec == section_count)
7357 if (map->includes_filehdr && lowest_section != NULL)
7359 /* Try to keep the space used by the headers plus any
7360 padding fixed. If there are sections with file contents
7361 in this segment then the lowest sh_offset is the best
7362 guess. Otherwise the segment only has file contents for
7363 the headers, and p_filesz is the best guess. */
7365 map->header_size = segment->p_filesz;
7367 map->header_size = lowest_section->filepos;
7370 if (!map->includes_phdrs
7371 && !map->includes_filehdr
7372 && map->p_paddr_valid)
7373 /* There is some other padding before the first section. */
7374 map->p_vaddr_offset = ((lowest_section ? lowest_section->lma : 0)
7375 - segment->p_paddr);
7377 map->count = section_count;
7378 *pointer_to_map = map;
7379 pointer_to_map = &map->next;
7382 elf_seg_map (obfd) = map_first;
7386 /* Copy private BFD data. This copies or rewrites ELF program header
7390 copy_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
7392 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
7393 || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
7396 if (elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr == NULL)
7399 if (ibfd->xvec == obfd->xvec)
7401 /* Check to see if any sections in the input BFD
7402 covered by ELF program header have changed. */
7403 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment;
7404 asection *section, *osec;
7405 unsigned int i, num_segments;
7406 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
7407 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
7409 bed = get_elf_backend_data (ibfd);
7411 /* Regenerate the segment map if p_paddr is set to 0. */
7412 if (bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero)
7415 /* Initialize the segment mark field. */
7416 for (section = obfd->sections; section != NULL;
7417 section = section->next)
7418 section->segment_mark = FALSE;
7420 num_segments = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_phnum;
7421 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
7425 /* PR binutils/3535. The Solaris linker always sets the p_paddr
7426 and p_memsz fields of special segments (DYNAMIC, INTERP) to 0
7427 which severly confuses things, so always regenerate the segment
7428 map in this case. */
7429 if (segment->p_paddr == 0
7430 && segment->p_memsz == 0
7431 && (segment->p_type == PT_INTERP || segment->p_type == PT_DYNAMIC))
7434 for (section = ibfd->sections;
7435 section != NULL; section = section->next)
7437 /* We mark the output section so that we know it comes
7438 from the input BFD. */
7439 osec = section->output_section;
7441 osec->segment_mark = TRUE;
7443 /* Check if this section is covered by the segment. */
7444 this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(section)->this_hdr);
7445 if (ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (this_hdr, segment))
7447 /* FIXME: Check if its output section is changed or
7448 removed. What else do we need to check? */
7450 || section->flags != osec->flags
7451 || section->lma != osec->lma
7452 || section->vma != osec->vma
7453 || section->size != osec->size
7454 || section->rawsize != osec->rawsize
7455 || section->alignment_power != osec->alignment_power)
7461 /* Check to see if any output section do not come from the
7463 for (section = obfd->sections; section != NULL;
7464 section = section->next)
7466 if (!section->segment_mark)
7469 section->segment_mark = FALSE;
7472 return copy_elf_program_header (ibfd, obfd);
7476 if (ibfd->xvec == obfd->xvec)
7478 /* When rewriting program header, set the output maxpagesize to
7479 the maximum alignment of input PT_LOAD segments. */
7480 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment;
7482 unsigned int num_segments = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_phnum;
7483 bfd_vma maxpagesize = 0;
7485 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
7488 if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD
7489 && maxpagesize < segment->p_align)
7491 /* PR 17512: file: f17299af. */
7492 if (segment->p_align > (bfd_vma) 1 << ((sizeof (bfd_vma) * 8) - 2))
7493 /* xgettext:c-format */
7494 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: warning: segment alignment of %#"
7495 PRIx64 " is too large"),
7496 ibfd, (uint64_t) segment->p_align);
7498 maxpagesize = segment->p_align;
7501 if (maxpagesize != get_elf_backend_data (obfd)->maxpagesize)
7502 bfd_emul_set_maxpagesize (bfd_get_target (obfd), maxpagesize);
7505 return rewrite_elf_program_header (ibfd, obfd);
7508 /* Initialize private output section information from input section. */
7511 _bfd_elf_init_private_section_data (bfd *ibfd,
7515 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
7518 Elf_Internal_Shdr *ihdr, *ohdr;
7519 bfd_boolean final_link = (link_info != NULL
7520 && !bfd_link_relocatable (link_info));
7522 if (ibfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour
7523 || obfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
7526 BFD_ASSERT (elf_section_data (osec) != NULL);
7528 /* For objcopy and relocatable link, don't copy the output ELF
7529 section type from input if the output BFD section flags have been
7530 set to something different. For a final link allow some flags
7531 that the linker clears to differ. */
7532 if (elf_section_type (osec) == SHT_NULL
7533 && (osec->flags == isec->flags
7535 && ((osec->flags ^ isec->flags)
7536 & ~(SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES | SEC_RELOC)) == 0)))
7537 elf_section_type (osec) = elf_section_type (isec);
7539 /* FIXME: Is this correct for all OS/PROC specific flags? */
7540 elf_section_flags (osec) |= (elf_section_flags (isec)
7541 & (SHF_MASKOS | SHF_MASKPROC));
7543 /* Copy sh_info from input for mbind section. */
7544 if (elf_section_flags (isec) & SHF_GNU_MBIND)
7545 elf_section_data (osec)->this_hdr.sh_info
7546 = elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.sh_info;
7548 /* Set things up for objcopy and relocatable link. The output
7549 SHT_GROUP section will have its elf_next_in_group pointing back
7550 to the input group members. Ignore linker created group section.
7551 See elfNN_ia64_object_p in elfxx-ia64.c. */
7552 if ((link_info == NULL
7553 || !link_info->resolve_section_groups)
7554 && (elf_sec_group (isec) == NULL
7555 || (elf_sec_group (isec)->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) == 0))
7557 if (elf_section_flags (isec) & SHF_GROUP)
7558 elf_section_flags (osec) |= SHF_GROUP;
7559 elf_next_in_group (osec) = elf_next_in_group (isec);
7560 elf_section_data (osec)->group = elf_section_data (isec)->group;
7563 /* If not decompress, preserve SHF_COMPRESSED. */
7564 if (!final_link && (ibfd->flags & BFD_DECOMPRESS) == 0)
7565 elf_section_flags (osec) |= (elf_section_flags (isec)
7568 ihdr = &elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr;
7570 /* We need to handle elf_linked_to_section for SHF_LINK_ORDER. We
7571 don't use the output section of the linked-to section since it
7572 may be NULL at this point. */
7573 if ((ihdr->sh_flags & SHF_LINK_ORDER) != 0)
7575 ohdr = &elf_section_data (osec)->this_hdr;
7576 ohdr->sh_flags |= SHF_LINK_ORDER;
7577 elf_linked_to_section (osec) = elf_linked_to_section (isec);
7580 osec->use_rela_p = isec->use_rela_p;
7585 /* Copy private section information. This copies over the entsize
7586 field, and sometimes the info field. */
7589 _bfd_elf_copy_private_section_data (bfd *ibfd,
7594 Elf_Internal_Shdr *ihdr, *ohdr;
7596 if (ibfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour
7597 || obfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
7600 ihdr = &elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr;
7601 ohdr = &elf_section_data (osec)->this_hdr;
7603 ohdr->sh_entsize = ihdr->sh_entsize;
7605 if (ihdr->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB
7606 || ihdr->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM
7607 || ihdr->sh_type == SHT_GNU_verneed
7608 || ihdr->sh_type == SHT_GNU_verdef)
7609 ohdr->sh_info = ihdr->sh_info;
7611 return _bfd_elf_init_private_section_data (ibfd, isec, obfd, osec,
7615 /* Look at all the SHT_GROUP sections in IBFD, making any adjustments
7616 necessary if we are removing either the SHT_GROUP section or any of
7617 the group member sections. DISCARDED is the value that a section's
7618 output_section has if the section will be discarded, NULL when this
7619 function is called from objcopy, bfd_abs_section_ptr when called
7623 _bfd_elf_fixup_group_sections (bfd *ibfd, asection *discarded)
7627 for (isec = ibfd->sections; isec != NULL; isec = isec->next)
7628 if (elf_section_type (isec) == SHT_GROUP)
7630 asection *first = elf_next_in_group (isec);
7631 asection *s = first;
7632 bfd_size_type removed = 0;
7636 /* If this member section is being output but the
7637 SHT_GROUP section is not, then clear the group info
7638 set up by _bfd_elf_copy_private_section_data. */
7639 if (s->output_section != discarded
7640 && isec->output_section == discarded)
7642 elf_section_flags (s->output_section) &= ~SHF_GROUP;
7643 elf_group_name (s->output_section) = NULL;
7645 /* Conversely, if the member section is not being output
7646 but the SHT_GROUP section is, then adjust its size. */
7647 else if (s->output_section == discarded
7648 && isec->output_section != discarded)
7650 struct bfd_elf_section_data *elf_sec = elf_section_data (s);
7652 if (elf_sec->rel.hdr != NULL
7653 && (elf_sec->rel.hdr->sh_flags & SHF_GROUP) != 0)
7655 if (elf_sec->rela.hdr != NULL
7656 && (elf_sec->rela.hdr->sh_flags & SHF_GROUP) != 0)
7659 s = elf_next_in_group (s);
7665 if (discarded != NULL)
7667 /* If we've been called for ld -r, then we need to
7668 adjust the input section size. */
7669 if (isec->rawsize == 0)
7670 isec->rawsize = isec->size;
7671 isec->size = isec->rawsize - removed;
7672 if (isec->size <= 4)
7675 isec->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
7680 /* Adjust the output section size when called from
7682 isec->output_section->size -= removed;
7683 if (isec->output_section->size <= 4)
7685 isec->output_section->size = 0;
7686 isec->output_section->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
7695 /* Copy private header information. */
7698 _bfd_elf_copy_private_header_data (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
7700 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
7701 || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
7704 /* Copy over private BFD data if it has not already been copied.
7705 This must be done here, rather than in the copy_private_bfd_data
7706 entry point, because the latter is called after the section
7707 contents have been set, which means that the program headers have
7708 already been worked out. */
7709 if (elf_seg_map (obfd) == NULL && elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr != NULL)
7711 if (! copy_private_bfd_data (ibfd, obfd))
7715 return _bfd_elf_fixup_group_sections (ibfd, NULL);
7718 /* Copy private symbol information. If this symbol is in a section
7719 which we did not map into a BFD section, try to map the section
7720 index correctly. We use special macro definitions for the mapped
7721 section indices; these definitions are interpreted by the
7722 swap_out_syms function. */
7724 #define MAP_ONESYMTAB (SHN_HIOS + 1)
7725 #define MAP_DYNSYMTAB (SHN_HIOS + 2)
7726 #define MAP_STRTAB (SHN_HIOS + 3)
7727 #define MAP_SHSTRTAB (SHN_HIOS + 4)
7728 #define MAP_SYM_SHNDX (SHN_HIOS + 5)
7731 _bfd_elf_copy_private_symbol_data (bfd *ibfd,
7736 elf_symbol_type *isym, *osym;
7738 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
7739 || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
7742 isym = elf_symbol_from (ibfd, isymarg);
7743 osym = elf_symbol_from (obfd, osymarg);
7746 && isym->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx != 0
7748 && bfd_is_abs_section (isym->symbol.section))
7752 shndx = isym->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx;
7753 if (shndx == elf_onesymtab (ibfd))
7754 shndx = MAP_ONESYMTAB;
7755 else if (shndx == elf_dynsymtab (ibfd))
7756 shndx = MAP_DYNSYMTAB;
7757 else if (shndx == elf_strtab_sec (ibfd))
7759 else if (shndx == elf_shstrtab_sec (ibfd))
7760 shndx = MAP_SHSTRTAB;
7761 else if (find_section_in_list (shndx, elf_symtab_shndx_list (ibfd)))
7762 shndx = MAP_SYM_SHNDX;
7763 osym->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx = shndx;
7769 /* Swap out the symbols. */
7772 swap_out_syms (bfd *abfd,
7773 struct elf_strtab_hash **sttp,
7776 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
7779 struct elf_strtab_hash *stt;
7780 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
7781 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_shndx_hdr;
7782 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symstrtab_hdr;
7783 struct elf_sym_strtab *symstrtab;
7784 bfd_byte *outbound_syms;
7785 bfd_byte *outbound_shndx;
7786 unsigned long outbound_syms_index;
7787 unsigned long outbound_shndx_index;
7789 unsigned int num_locals;
7791 bfd_boolean name_local_sections;
7793 if (!elf_map_symbols (abfd, &num_locals))
7796 /* Dump out the symtabs. */
7797 stt = _bfd_elf_strtab_init ();
7801 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
7802 symcount = bfd_get_symcount (abfd);
7803 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
7804 symtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_SYMTAB;
7805 symtab_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_sym;
7806 symtab_hdr->sh_size = symtab_hdr->sh_entsize * (symcount + 1);
7807 symtab_hdr->sh_info = num_locals + 1;
7808 symtab_hdr->sh_addralign = (bfd_vma) 1 << bed->s->log_file_align;
7810 symstrtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr;
7811 symstrtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_STRTAB;
7813 /* Allocate buffer to swap out the .strtab section. */
7814 symstrtab = (struct elf_sym_strtab *) bfd_malloc ((symcount + 1)
7815 * sizeof (*symstrtab));
7816 if (symstrtab == NULL)
7818 _bfd_elf_strtab_free (stt);
7822 outbound_syms = (bfd_byte *) bfd_alloc2 (abfd, 1 + symcount,
7823 bed->s->sizeof_sym);
7824 if (outbound_syms == NULL)
7827 _bfd_elf_strtab_free (stt);
7831 symtab_hdr->contents = outbound_syms;
7832 outbound_syms_index = 0;
7834 outbound_shndx = NULL;
7835 outbound_shndx_index = 0;
7837 if (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd))
7839 symtab_shndx_hdr = & elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd)->hdr;
7840 if (symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_name != 0)
7842 amt = (bfd_size_type) (1 + symcount) * sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
7843 outbound_shndx = (bfd_byte *)
7844 bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, 1 + symcount, sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx));
7845 if (outbound_shndx == NULL)
7848 symtab_shndx_hdr->contents = outbound_shndx;
7849 symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_type = SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX;
7850 symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_size = amt;
7851 symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_addralign = sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
7852 symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
7854 /* FIXME: What about any other headers in the list ? */
7857 /* Now generate the data (for "contents"). */
7859 /* Fill in zeroth symbol and swap it out. */
7860 Elf_Internal_Sym sym;
7866 sym.st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
7867 sym.st_target_internal = 0;
7868 symstrtab[0].sym = sym;
7869 symstrtab[0].dest_index = outbound_syms_index;
7870 symstrtab[0].destshndx_index = outbound_shndx_index;
7871 outbound_syms_index++;
7872 if (outbound_shndx != NULL)
7873 outbound_shndx_index++;
7877 = (bed->elf_backend_name_local_section_symbols
7878 && bed->elf_backend_name_local_section_symbols (abfd));
7880 syms = bfd_get_outsymbols (abfd);
7881 for (idx = 0; idx < symcount;)
7883 Elf_Internal_Sym sym;
7884 bfd_vma value = syms[idx]->value;
7885 elf_symbol_type *type_ptr;
7886 flagword flags = syms[idx]->flags;
7889 if (!name_local_sections
7890 && (flags & (BSF_SECTION_SYM | BSF_GLOBAL)) == BSF_SECTION_SYM)
7892 /* Local section symbols have no name. */
7893 sym.st_name = (unsigned long) -1;
7897 /* Call _bfd_elf_strtab_offset after _bfd_elf_strtab_finalize
7898 to get the final offset for st_name. */
7900 = (unsigned long) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (stt, syms[idx]->name,
7902 if (sym.st_name == (unsigned long) -1)
7906 type_ptr = elf_symbol_from (abfd, syms[idx]);
7908 if ((flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) == 0
7909 && bfd_is_com_section (syms[idx]->section))
7911 /* ELF common symbols put the alignment into the `value' field,
7912 and the size into the `size' field. This is backwards from
7913 how BFD handles it, so reverse it here. */
7914 sym.st_size = value;
7915 if (type_ptr == NULL
7916 || type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_value == 0)
7917 sym.st_value = value >= 16 ? 16 : (1 << bfd_log2 (value));
7919 sym.st_value = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_value;
7920 sym.st_shndx = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section
7921 (abfd, syms[idx]->section);
7925 asection *sec = syms[idx]->section;
7928 if (sec->output_section)
7930 value += sec->output_offset;
7931 sec = sec->output_section;
7934 /* Don't add in the section vma for relocatable output. */
7935 if (! relocatable_p)
7937 sym.st_value = value;
7938 sym.st_size = type_ptr ? type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_size : 0;
7940 if (bfd_is_abs_section (sec)
7942 && type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx != 0)
7944 /* This symbol is in a real ELF section which we did
7945 not create as a BFD section. Undo the mapping done
7946 by copy_private_symbol_data. */
7947 shndx = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx;
7951 shndx = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
7954 shndx = elf_dynsymtab (abfd);
7957 shndx = elf_strtab_sec (abfd);
7960 shndx = elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd);
7963 if (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd))
7964 shndx = elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd)->ndx;
7973 shndx = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (abfd, sec);
7975 if (shndx == SHN_BAD)
7979 /* Writing this would be a hell of a lot easier if
7980 we had some decent documentation on bfd, and
7981 knew what to expect of the library, and what to
7982 demand of applications. For example, it
7983 appears that `objcopy' might not set the
7984 section of a symbol to be a section that is
7985 actually in the output file. */
7986 sec2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, sec->name);
7988 shndx = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (abfd, sec2);
7989 if (shndx == SHN_BAD)
7991 /* xgettext:c-format */
7993 (_("unable to find equivalent output section"
7994 " for symbol '%s' from section '%s'"),
7995 syms[idx]->name ? syms[idx]->name : "<Local sym>",
7997 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
8003 sym.st_shndx = shndx;
8006 if ((flags & BSF_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)
8008 else if ((flags & BSF_GNU_INDIRECT_FUNCTION) != 0)
8009 type = STT_GNU_IFUNC;
8010 else if ((flags & BSF_FUNCTION) != 0)
8012 else if ((flags & BSF_OBJECT) != 0)
8014 else if ((flags & BSF_RELC) != 0)
8016 else if ((flags & BSF_SRELC) != 0)
8021 if (syms[idx]->section->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
8024 /* Processor-specific types. */
8025 if (type_ptr != NULL
8026 && bed->elf_backend_get_symbol_type)
8027 type = ((*bed->elf_backend_get_symbol_type)
8028 (&type_ptr->internal_elf_sym, type));
8030 if (flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM)
8032 if (flags & BSF_GLOBAL)
8033 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
8035 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_LOCAL, STT_SECTION);
8037 else if (bfd_is_com_section (syms[idx]->section))
8039 if (type != STT_TLS)
8041 if ((abfd->flags & BFD_CONVERT_ELF_COMMON))
8042 type = ((abfd->flags & BFD_USE_ELF_STT_COMMON)
8043 ? STT_COMMON : STT_OBJECT);
8045 type = ((flags & BSF_ELF_COMMON) != 0
8046 ? STT_COMMON : STT_OBJECT);
8048 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, type);
8050 else if (bfd_is_und_section (syms[idx]->section))
8051 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (((flags & BSF_WEAK)
8055 else if (flags & BSF_FILE)
8056 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_LOCAL, STT_FILE);
8059 int bind = STB_LOCAL;
8061 if (flags & BSF_LOCAL)
8063 else if (flags & BSF_GNU_UNIQUE)
8064 bind = STB_GNU_UNIQUE;
8065 else if (flags & BSF_WEAK)
8067 else if (flags & BSF_GLOBAL)
8070 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (bind, type);
8073 if (type_ptr != NULL)
8075 sym.st_other = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_other;
8076 sym.st_target_internal
8077 = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_target_internal;
8082 sym.st_target_internal = 0;
8086 symstrtab[idx].sym = sym;
8087 symstrtab[idx].dest_index = outbound_syms_index;
8088 symstrtab[idx].destshndx_index = outbound_shndx_index;
8090 outbound_syms_index++;
8091 if (outbound_shndx != NULL)
8092 outbound_shndx_index++;
8095 /* Finalize the .strtab section. */
8096 _bfd_elf_strtab_finalize (stt);
8098 /* Swap out the .strtab section. */
8099 for (idx = 0; idx <= symcount; idx++)
8101 struct elf_sym_strtab *elfsym = &symstrtab[idx];
8102 if (elfsym->sym.st_name == (unsigned long) -1)
8103 elfsym->sym.st_name = 0;
8105 elfsym->sym.st_name = _bfd_elf_strtab_offset (stt,
8106 elfsym->sym.st_name);
8107 bed->s->swap_symbol_out (abfd, &elfsym->sym,
8109 + (elfsym->dest_index
8110 * bed->s->sizeof_sym)),
8112 + (elfsym->destshndx_index
8113 * sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx))));
8118 symstrtab_hdr->sh_size = _bfd_elf_strtab_size (stt);
8119 symstrtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_STRTAB;
8120 symstrtab_hdr->sh_flags = bed->elf_strtab_flags;
8121 symstrtab_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
8122 symstrtab_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
8123 symstrtab_hdr->sh_link = 0;
8124 symstrtab_hdr->sh_info = 0;
8125 symstrtab_hdr->sh_addralign = 1;
8130 /* Return the number of bytes required to hold the symtab vector.
8132 Note that we base it on the count plus 1, since we will null terminate
8133 the vector allocated based on this size. However, the ELF symbol table
8134 always has a dummy entry as symbol #0, so it ends up even. */
8137 _bfd_elf_get_symtab_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
8141 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
8143 symcount = hdr->sh_size / get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_sym;
8144 symtab_size = (symcount + 1) * (sizeof (asymbol *));
8146 symtab_size -= sizeof (asymbol *);
8152 _bfd_elf_get_dynamic_symtab_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
8156 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynsymtab_hdr;
8158 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
8160 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
8164 symcount = hdr->sh_size / get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_sym;
8165 symtab_size = (symcount + 1) * (sizeof (asymbol *));
8167 symtab_size -= sizeof (asymbol *);
8173 _bfd_elf_get_reloc_upper_bound (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8176 return (asect->reloc_count + 1) * sizeof (arelent *);
8179 /* Canonicalize the relocs. */
8182 _bfd_elf_canonicalize_reloc (bfd *abfd,
8189 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
8191 if (! bed->s->slurp_reloc_table (abfd, section, symbols, FALSE))
8194 tblptr = section->relocation;
8195 for (i = 0; i < section->reloc_count; i++)
8196 *relptr++ = tblptr++;
8200 return section->reloc_count;
8204 _bfd_elf_canonicalize_symtab (bfd *abfd, asymbol **allocation)
8206 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
8207 long symcount = bed->s->slurp_symbol_table (abfd, allocation, FALSE);
8210 bfd_get_symcount (abfd) = symcount;
8215 _bfd_elf_canonicalize_dynamic_symtab (bfd *abfd,
8216 asymbol **allocation)
8218 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
8219 long symcount = bed->s->slurp_symbol_table (abfd, allocation, TRUE);
8222 bfd_get_dynamic_symcount (abfd) = symcount;
8226 /* Return the size required for the dynamic reloc entries. Any loadable
8227 section that was actually installed in the BFD, and has type SHT_REL
8228 or SHT_RELA, and uses the dynamic symbol table, is considered to be a
8229 dynamic reloc section. */
8232 _bfd_elf_get_dynamic_reloc_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
8237 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
8239 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
8243 ret = sizeof (arelent *);
8244 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
8245 if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_link == elf_dynsymtab (abfd)
8246 && (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_REL
8247 || elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_RELA))
8248 ret += ((s->size / elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize)
8249 * sizeof (arelent *));
8254 /* Canonicalize the dynamic relocation entries. Note that we return the
8255 dynamic relocations as a single block, although they are actually
8256 associated with particular sections; the interface, which was
8257 designed for SunOS style shared libraries, expects that there is only
8258 one set of dynamic relocs. Any loadable section that was actually
8259 installed in the BFD, and has type SHT_REL or SHT_RELA, and uses the
8260 dynamic symbol table, is considered to be a dynamic reloc section. */
8263 _bfd_elf_canonicalize_dynamic_reloc (bfd *abfd,
8267 bfd_boolean (*slurp_relocs) (bfd *, asection *, asymbol **, bfd_boolean);
8271 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
8273 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
8277 slurp_relocs = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->slurp_reloc_table;
8279 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
8281 if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_link == elf_dynsymtab (abfd)
8282 && (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_REL
8283 || elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_RELA))
8288 if (! (*slurp_relocs) (abfd, s, syms, TRUE))
8290 count = s->size / elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize;
8292 for (i = 0; i < count; i++)
8303 /* Read in the version information. */
8306 _bfd_elf_slurp_version_tables (bfd *abfd, bfd_boolean default_imported_symver)
8308 bfd_byte *contents = NULL;
8309 unsigned int freeidx = 0;
8311 if (elf_dynverref (abfd) != 0)
8313 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
8314 Elf_External_Verneed *everneed;
8315 Elf_Internal_Verneed *iverneed;
8317 bfd_byte *contents_end;
8319 hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverref_hdr;
8321 if (hdr->sh_info == 0
8322 || hdr->sh_info > hdr->sh_size / sizeof (Elf_External_Verneed))
8324 error_return_bad_verref:
8326 (_("%pB: .gnu.version_r invalid entry"), abfd);
8327 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8328 error_return_verref:
8329 elf_tdata (abfd)->verref = NULL;
8330 elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs = 0;
8334 contents = (bfd_byte *) bfd_malloc (hdr->sh_size);
8335 if (contents == NULL)
8336 goto error_return_verref;
8338 if (bfd_seek (abfd, hdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
8339 || bfd_bread (contents, hdr->sh_size, abfd) != hdr->sh_size)
8340 goto error_return_verref;
8342 elf_tdata (abfd)->verref = (Elf_Internal_Verneed *)
8343 bfd_alloc2 (abfd, hdr->sh_info, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verneed));
8345 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->verref == NULL)
8346 goto error_return_verref;
8348 BFD_ASSERT (sizeof (Elf_External_Verneed)
8349 == sizeof (Elf_External_Vernaux));
8350 contents_end = contents + hdr->sh_size - sizeof (Elf_External_Verneed);
8351 everneed = (Elf_External_Verneed *) contents;
8352 iverneed = elf_tdata (abfd)->verref;
8353 for (i = 0; i < hdr->sh_info; i++, iverneed++)
8355 Elf_External_Vernaux *evernaux;
8356 Elf_Internal_Vernaux *ivernaux;
8359 _bfd_elf_swap_verneed_in (abfd, everneed, iverneed);
8361 iverneed->vn_bfd = abfd;
8363 iverneed->vn_filename =
8364 bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, hdr->sh_link,
8366 if (iverneed->vn_filename == NULL)
8367 goto error_return_bad_verref;
8369 if (iverneed->vn_cnt == 0)
8370 iverneed->vn_auxptr = NULL;
8373 iverneed->vn_auxptr = (struct elf_internal_vernaux *)
8374 bfd_alloc2 (abfd, iverneed->vn_cnt,
8375 sizeof (Elf_Internal_Vernaux));
8376 if (iverneed->vn_auxptr == NULL)
8377 goto error_return_verref;
8380 if (iverneed->vn_aux
8381 > (size_t) (contents_end - (bfd_byte *) everneed))
8382 goto error_return_bad_verref;
8384 evernaux = ((Elf_External_Vernaux *)
8385 ((bfd_byte *) everneed + iverneed->vn_aux));
8386 ivernaux = iverneed->vn_auxptr;
8387 for (j = 0; j < iverneed->vn_cnt; j++, ivernaux++)
8389 _bfd_elf_swap_vernaux_in (abfd, evernaux, ivernaux);
8391 ivernaux->vna_nodename =
8392 bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, hdr->sh_link,
8393 ivernaux->vna_name);
8394 if (ivernaux->vna_nodename == NULL)
8395 goto error_return_bad_verref;
8397 if (ivernaux->vna_other > freeidx)
8398 freeidx = ivernaux->vna_other;
8400 ivernaux->vna_nextptr = NULL;
8401 if (ivernaux->vna_next == 0)
8403 iverneed->vn_cnt = j + 1;
8406 if (j + 1 < iverneed->vn_cnt)
8407 ivernaux->vna_nextptr = ivernaux + 1;
8409 if (ivernaux->vna_next
8410 > (size_t) (contents_end - (bfd_byte *) evernaux))
8411 goto error_return_bad_verref;
8413 evernaux = ((Elf_External_Vernaux *)
8414 ((bfd_byte *) evernaux + ivernaux->vna_next));
8417 iverneed->vn_nextref = NULL;
8418 if (iverneed->vn_next == 0)
8420 if (i + 1 < hdr->sh_info)
8421 iverneed->vn_nextref = iverneed + 1;
8423 if (iverneed->vn_next
8424 > (size_t) (contents_end - (bfd_byte *) everneed))
8425 goto error_return_bad_verref;
8427 everneed = ((Elf_External_Verneed *)
8428 ((bfd_byte *) everneed + iverneed->vn_next));
8430 elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs = i;
8436 if (elf_dynverdef (abfd) != 0)
8438 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
8439 Elf_External_Verdef *everdef;
8440 Elf_Internal_Verdef *iverdef;
8441 Elf_Internal_Verdef *iverdefarr;
8442 Elf_Internal_Verdef iverdefmem;
8444 unsigned int maxidx;
8445 bfd_byte *contents_end_def, *contents_end_aux;
8447 hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverdef_hdr;
8449 if (hdr->sh_info == 0 || hdr->sh_size < sizeof (Elf_External_Verdef))
8451 error_return_bad_verdef:
8453 (_("%pB: .gnu.version_d invalid entry"), abfd);
8454 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8455 error_return_verdef:
8456 elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef = NULL;
8457 elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs = 0;
8461 contents = (bfd_byte *) bfd_malloc (hdr->sh_size);
8462 if (contents == NULL)
8463 goto error_return_verdef;
8464 if (bfd_seek (abfd, hdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
8465 || bfd_bread (contents, hdr->sh_size, abfd) != hdr->sh_size)
8466 goto error_return_verdef;
8468 BFD_ASSERT (sizeof (Elf_External_Verdef)
8469 >= sizeof (Elf_External_Verdaux));
8470 contents_end_def = contents + hdr->sh_size
8471 - sizeof (Elf_External_Verdef);
8472 contents_end_aux = contents + hdr->sh_size
8473 - sizeof (Elf_External_Verdaux);
8475 /* We know the number of entries in the section but not the maximum
8476 index. Therefore we have to run through all entries and find
8478 everdef = (Elf_External_Verdef *) contents;
8480 for (i = 0; i < hdr->sh_info; ++i)
8482 _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_in (abfd, everdef, &iverdefmem);
8484 if ((iverdefmem.vd_ndx & ((unsigned) VERSYM_VERSION)) == 0)
8485 goto error_return_bad_verdef;
8486 if ((iverdefmem.vd_ndx & ((unsigned) VERSYM_VERSION)) > maxidx)
8487 maxidx = iverdefmem.vd_ndx & ((unsigned) VERSYM_VERSION);
8489 if (iverdefmem.vd_next == 0)
8492 if (iverdefmem.vd_next
8493 > (size_t) (contents_end_def - (bfd_byte *) everdef))
8494 goto error_return_bad_verdef;
8496 everdef = ((Elf_External_Verdef *)
8497 ((bfd_byte *) everdef + iverdefmem.vd_next));
8500 if (default_imported_symver)
8502 if (freeidx > maxidx)
8508 elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef = (Elf_Internal_Verdef *)
8509 bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, maxidx, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdef));
8510 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef == NULL)
8511 goto error_return_verdef;
8513 elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs = maxidx;
8515 everdef = (Elf_External_Verdef *) contents;
8516 iverdefarr = elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef;
8517 for (i = 0; i < hdr->sh_info; i++)
8519 Elf_External_Verdaux *everdaux;
8520 Elf_Internal_Verdaux *iverdaux;
8523 _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_in (abfd, everdef, &iverdefmem);
8525 if ((iverdefmem.vd_ndx & VERSYM_VERSION) == 0)
8526 goto error_return_bad_verdef;
8528 iverdef = &iverdefarr[(iverdefmem.vd_ndx & VERSYM_VERSION) - 1];
8529 memcpy (iverdef, &iverdefmem, offsetof (Elf_Internal_Verdef, vd_bfd));
8531 iverdef->vd_bfd = abfd;
8533 if (iverdef->vd_cnt == 0)
8534 iverdef->vd_auxptr = NULL;
8537 iverdef->vd_auxptr = (struct elf_internal_verdaux *)
8538 bfd_alloc2 (abfd, iverdef->vd_cnt,
8539 sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdaux));
8540 if (iverdef->vd_auxptr == NULL)
8541 goto error_return_verdef;
8545 > (size_t) (contents_end_aux - (bfd_byte *) everdef))
8546 goto error_return_bad_verdef;
8548 everdaux = ((Elf_External_Verdaux *)
8549 ((bfd_byte *) everdef + iverdef->vd_aux));
8550 iverdaux = iverdef->vd_auxptr;
8551 for (j = 0; j < iverdef->vd_cnt; j++, iverdaux++)
8553 _bfd_elf_swap_verdaux_in (abfd, everdaux, iverdaux);
8555 iverdaux->vda_nodename =
8556 bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, hdr->sh_link,
8557 iverdaux->vda_name);
8558 if (iverdaux->vda_nodename == NULL)
8559 goto error_return_bad_verdef;
8561 iverdaux->vda_nextptr = NULL;
8562 if (iverdaux->vda_next == 0)
8564 iverdef->vd_cnt = j + 1;
8567 if (j + 1 < iverdef->vd_cnt)
8568 iverdaux->vda_nextptr = iverdaux + 1;
8570 if (iverdaux->vda_next
8571 > (size_t) (contents_end_aux - (bfd_byte *) everdaux))
8572 goto error_return_bad_verdef;
8574 everdaux = ((Elf_External_Verdaux *)
8575 ((bfd_byte *) everdaux + iverdaux->vda_next));
8578 iverdef->vd_nodename = NULL;
8579 if (iverdef->vd_cnt)
8580 iverdef->vd_nodename = iverdef->vd_auxptr->vda_nodename;
8582 iverdef->vd_nextdef = NULL;
8583 if (iverdef->vd_next == 0)
8585 if ((size_t) (iverdef - iverdefarr) + 1 < maxidx)
8586 iverdef->vd_nextdef = iverdef + 1;
8588 everdef = ((Elf_External_Verdef *)
8589 ((bfd_byte *) everdef + iverdef->vd_next));
8595 else if (default_imported_symver)
8602 elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef = (Elf_Internal_Verdef *)
8603 bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, freeidx, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdef));
8604 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef == NULL)
8607 elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs = freeidx;
8610 /* Create a default version based on the soname. */
8611 if (default_imported_symver)
8613 Elf_Internal_Verdef *iverdef;
8614 Elf_Internal_Verdaux *iverdaux;
8616 iverdef = &elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef[freeidx - 1];
8618 iverdef->vd_version = VER_DEF_CURRENT;
8619 iverdef->vd_flags = 0;
8620 iverdef->vd_ndx = freeidx;
8621 iverdef->vd_cnt = 1;
8623 iverdef->vd_bfd = abfd;
8625 iverdef->vd_nodename = bfd_elf_get_dt_soname (abfd);
8626 if (iverdef->vd_nodename == NULL)
8627 goto error_return_verdef;
8628 iverdef->vd_nextdef = NULL;
8629 iverdef->vd_auxptr = ((struct elf_internal_verdaux *)
8630 bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdaux)));
8631 if (iverdef->vd_auxptr == NULL)
8632 goto error_return_verdef;
8634 iverdaux = iverdef->vd_auxptr;
8635 iverdaux->vda_nodename = iverdef->vd_nodename;
8641 if (contents != NULL)
8647 _bfd_elf_make_empty_symbol (bfd *abfd)
8649 elf_symbol_type *newsym;
8651 newsym = (elf_symbol_type *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof * newsym);
8654 newsym->symbol.the_bfd = abfd;
8655 return &newsym->symbol;
8659 _bfd_elf_get_symbol_info (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8663 bfd_symbol_info (symbol, ret);
8666 /* Return whether a symbol name implies a local symbol. Most targets
8667 use this function for the is_local_label_name entry point, but some
8671 _bfd_elf_is_local_label_name (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8674 /* Normal local symbols start with ``.L''. */
8675 if (name[0] == '.' && name[1] == 'L')
8678 /* At least some SVR4 compilers (e.g., UnixWare 2.1 cc) generate
8679 DWARF debugging symbols starting with ``..''. */
8680 if (name[0] == '.' && name[1] == '.')
8683 /* gcc will sometimes generate symbols beginning with ``_.L_'' when
8684 emitting DWARF debugging output. I suspect this is actually a
8685 small bug in gcc (it calls ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL when it should call
8686 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL, and this causes the leading
8687 underscore to be emitted on some ELF targets). For ease of use,
8688 we treat such symbols as local. */
8689 if (name[0] == '_' && name[1] == '.' && name[2] == 'L' && name[3] == '_')
8692 /* Treat assembler generated fake symbols, dollar local labels and
8693 forward-backward labels (aka local labels) as locals.
8694 These labels have the form:
8696 L0^A.* (fake symbols)
8698 [.]?L[0123456789]+{^A|^B}[0123456789]* (local labels)
8700 Versions which start with .L will have already been matched above,
8701 so we only need to match the rest. */
8702 if (name[0] == 'L' && ISDIGIT (name[1]))
8704 bfd_boolean ret = FALSE;
8708 for (p = name + 2; (c = *p); p++)
8710 if (c == 1 || c == 2)
8712 if (c == 1 && p == name + 2)
8713 /* A fake symbol. */
8716 /* FIXME: We are being paranoid here and treating symbols like
8717 L0^Bfoo as if there were non-local, on the grounds that the
8718 assembler will never generate them. But can any symbol
8719 containing an ASCII value in the range 1-31 ever be anything
8720 other than some kind of local ? */
8737 _bfd_elf_get_lineno (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8738 asymbol *symbol ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
8745 _bfd_elf_set_arch_mach (bfd *abfd,
8746 enum bfd_architecture arch,
8747 unsigned long machine)
8749 /* If this isn't the right architecture for this backend, and this
8750 isn't the generic backend, fail. */
8751 if (arch != get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->arch
8752 && arch != bfd_arch_unknown
8753 && get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->arch != bfd_arch_unknown)
8756 return bfd_default_set_arch_mach (abfd, arch, machine);
8759 /* Find the nearest line to a particular section and offset,
8760 for error reporting. */
8763 _bfd_elf_find_nearest_line (bfd *abfd,
8767 const char **filename_ptr,
8768 const char **functionname_ptr,
8769 unsigned int *line_ptr,
8770 unsigned int *discriminator_ptr)
8774 if (_bfd_dwarf2_find_nearest_line (abfd, symbols, NULL, section, offset,
8775 filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
8776 line_ptr, discriminator_ptr,
8777 dwarf_debug_sections, 0,
8778 &elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info)
8779 || _bfd_dwarf1_find_nearest_line (abfd, symbols, section, offset,
8780 filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
8783 if (!*functionname_ptr)
8784 _bfd_elf_find_function (abfd, symbols, section, offset,
8785 *filename_ptr ? NULL : filename_ptr,
8790 if (! _bfd_stab_section_find_nearest_line (abfd, symbols, section, offset,
8791 &found, filename_ptr,
8792 functionname_ptr, line_ptr,
8793 &elf_tdata (abfd)->line_info))
8795 if (found && (*functionname_ptr || *line_ptr))
8798 if (symbols == NULL)
8801 if (! _bfd_elf_find_function (abfd, symbols, section, offset,
8802 filename_ptr, functionname_ptr))
8809 /* Find the line for a symbol. */
8812 _bfd_elf_find_line (bfd *abfd, asymbol **symbols, asymbol *symbol,
8813 const char **filename_ptr, unsigned int *line_ptr)
8815 return _bfd_dwarf2_find_nearest_line (abfd, symbols, symbol, NULL, 0,
8816 filename_ptr, NULL, line_ptr, NULL,
8817 dwarf_debug_sections, 0,
8818 &elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info);
8821 /* After a call to bfd_find_nearest_line, successive calls to
8822 bfd_find_inliner_info can be used to get source information about
8823 each level of function inlining that terminated at the address
8824 passed to bfd_find_nearest_line. Currently this is only supported
8825 for DWARF2 with appropriate DWARF3 extensions. */
8828 _bfd_elf_find_inliner_info (bfd *abfd,
8829 const char **filename_ptr,
8830 const char **functionname_ptr,
8831 unsigned int *line_ptr)
8834 found = _bfd_dwarf2_find_inliner_info (abfd, filename_ptr,
8835 functionname_ptr, line_ptr,
8836 & elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info);
8841 _bfd_elf_sizeof_headers (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
8843 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
8844 int ret = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
8846 if (!bfd_link_relocatable (info))
8848 bfd_size_type phdr_size = elf_program_header_size (abfd);
8850 if (phdr_size == (bfd_size_type) -1)
8852 struct elf_segment_map *m;
8855 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
8856 phdr_size += bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
8859 phdr_size = get_program_header_size (abfd, info);
8862 elf_program_header_size (abfd) = phdr_size;
8870 _bfd_elf_set_section_contents (bfd *abfd,
8872 const void *location,
8874 bfd_size_type count)
8876 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
8879 if (! abfd->output_has_begun
8880 && ! _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions (abfd, NULL))
8886 hdr = &elf_section_data (section)->this_hdr;
8887 if (hdr->sh_offset == (file_ptr) -1)
8889 /* We must compress this section. Write output to the buffer. */
8890 unsigned char *contents = hdr->contents;
8891 if ((offset + count) > hdr->sh_size
8892 || (section->flags & SEC_ELF_COMPRESS) == 0
8893 || contents == NULL)
8895 memcpy (contents + offset, location, count);
8898 pos = hdr->sh_offset + offset;
8899 if (bfd_seek (abfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0
8900 || bfd_bwrite (location, count, abfd) != count)
8907 _bfd_elf_no_info_to_howto (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8908 arelent *cache_ptr ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8909 Elf_Internal_Rela *dst ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
8915 /* Try to convert a non-ELF reloc into an ELF one. */
8918 _bfd_elf_validate_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *areloc)
8920 /* Check whether we really have an ELF howto. */
8922 if ((*areloc->sym_ptr_ptr)->the_bfd->xvec != abfd->xvec)
8924 bfd_reloc_code_real_type code;
8925 reloc_howto_type *howto;
8927 /* Alien reloc: Try to determine its type to replace it with an
8928 equivalent ELF reloc. */
8930 if (areloc->howto->pc_relative)
8932 switch (areloc->howto->bitsize)
8935 code = BFD_RELOC_8_PCREL;
8938 code = BFD_RELOC_12_PCREL;
8941 code = BFD_RELOC_16_PCREL;
8944 code = BFD_RELOC_24_PCREL;
8947 code = BFD_RELOC_32_PCREL;
8950 code = BFD_RELOC_64_PCREL;
8956 howto = bfd_reloc_type_lookup (abfd, code);
8958 if (areloc->howto->pcrel_offset != howto->pcrel_offset)
8960 if (howto->pcrel_offset)
8961 areloc->addend += areloc->address;
8963 areloc->addend -= areloc->address; /* addend is unsigned!! */
8968 switch (areloc->howto->bitsize)
8974 code = BFD_RELOC_14;
8977 code = BFD_RELOC_16;
8980 code = BFD_RELOC_26;
8983 code = BFD_RELOC_32;
8986 code = BFD_RELOC_64;
8992 howto = bfd_reloc_type_lookup (abfd, code);
8996 areloc->howto = howto;
9004 /* xgettext:c-format */
9005 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: %s unsupported"),
9006 abfd, areloc->howto->name);
9007 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
9012 _bfd_elf_close_and_cleanup (bfd *abfd)
9014 struct elf_obj_tdata *tdata = elf_tdata (abfd);
9015 if (bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_object && tdata != NULL)
9017 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->o != NULL && elf_shstrtab (abfd) != NULL)
9018 _bfd_elf_strtab_free (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
9019 _bfd_dwarf2_cleanup_debug_info (abfd, &tdata->dwarf2_find_line_info);
9022 return _bfd_generic_close_and_cleanup (abfd);
9025 /* For Rel targets, we encode meaningful data for BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_ENTRY
9026 in the relocation's offset. Thus we cannot allow any sort of sanity
9027 range-checking to interfere. There is nothing else to do in processing
9030 bfd_reloc_status_type
9031 _bfd_elf_rel_vtable_reloc_fn
9032 (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, arelent *re ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9033 struct bfd_symbol *symbol ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9034 void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, asection *is ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9035 bfd *obfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, char **errmsg ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9037 return bfd_reloc_ok;
9040 /* Elf core file support. Much of this only works on native
9041 toolchains, since we rely on knowing the
9042 machine-dependent procfs structure in order to pick
9043 out details about the corefile. */
9045 #ifdef HAVE_SYS_PROCFS_H
9046 /* Needed for new procfs interface on sparc-solaris. */
9047 # define _STRUCTURED_PROC 1
9048 # include <sys/procfs.h>
9051 /* Return a PID that identifies a "thread" for threaded cores, or the
9052 PID of the main process for non-threaded cores. */
9055 elfcore_make_pid (bfd *abfd)
9059 pid = elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid;
9061 pid = elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid;
9066 /* If there isn't a section called NAME, make one, using
9067 data from SECT. Note, this function will generate a
9068 reference to NAME, so you shouldn't deallocate or
9072 elfcore_maybe_make_sect (bfd *abfd, char *name, asection *sect)
9076 if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, name) != NULL)
9079 sect2 = bfd_make_section_with_flags (abfd, name, sect->flags);
9083 sect2->size = sect->size;
9084 sect2->filepos = sect->filepos;
9085 sect2->alignment_power = sect->alignment_power;
9089 /* Create a pseudosection containing SIZE bytes at FILEPOS. This
9090 actually creates up to two pseudosections:
9091 - For the single-threaded case, a section named NAME, unless
9092 such a section already exists.
9093 - For the multi-threaded case, a section named "NAME/PID", where
9094 PID is elfcore_make_pid (abfd).
9095 Both pseudosections have identical contents. */
9097 _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (bfd *abfd,
9103 char *threaded_name;
9107 /* Build the section name. */
9109 sprintf (buf, "%s/%d", name, elfcore_make_pid (abfd));
9110 len = strlen (buf) + 1;
9111 threaded_name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
9112 if (threaded_name == NULL)
9114 memcpy (threaded_name, buf, len);
9116 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, threaded_name,
9121 sect->filepos = filepos;
9122 sect->alignment_power = 2;
9124 return elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, name, sect);
9127 /* prstatus_t exists on:
9129 linux 2.[01] + glibc
9133 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T)
9136 elfcore_grok_prstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9141 if (note->descsz == sizeof (prstatus_t))
9145 size = sizeof (prstat.pr_reg);
9146 offset = offsetof (prstatus_t, pr_reg);
9147 memcpy (&prstat, note->descdata, sizeof (prstat));
9149 /* Do not overwrite the core signal if it
9150 has already been set by another thread. */
9151 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal == 0)
9152 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = prstat.pr_cursig;
9153 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid == 0)
9154 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = prstat.pr_pid;
9156 /* pr_who exists on:
9159 pr_who doesn't exist on:
9162 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T_PR_WHO)
9163 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = prstat.pr_who;
9165 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = prstat.pr_pid;
9168 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T)
9169 else if (note->descsz == sizeof (prstatus32_t))
9171 /* 64-bit host, 32-bit corefile */
9172 prstatus32_t prstat;
9174 size = sizeof (prstat.pr_reg);
9175 offset = offsetof (prstatus32_t, pr_reg);
9176 memcpy (&prstat, note->descdata, sizeof (prstat));
9178 /* Do not overwrite the core signal if it
9179 has already been set by another thread. */
9180 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal == 0)
9181 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = prstat.pr_cursig;
9182 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid == 0)
9183 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = prstat.pr_pid;
9185 /* pr_who exists on:
9188 pr_who doesn't exist on:
9191 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T_PR_WHO)
9192 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = prstat.pr_who;
9194 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = prstat.pr_pid;
9197 #endif /* HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T */
9200 /* Fail - we don't know how to handle any other
9201 note size (ie. data object type). */
9205 /* Make a ".reg/999" section and a ".reg" section. */
9206 return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg",
9207 size, note->descpos + offset);
9209 #endif /* defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T) */
9211 /* Create a pseudosection containing the exact contents of NOTE. */
9213 elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (bfd *abfd,
9215 Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9217 return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, name,
9218 note->descsz, note->descpos);
9221 /* There isn't a consistent prfpregset_t across platforms,
9222 but it doesn't matter, because we don't have to pick this
9223 data structure apart. */
9226 elfcore_grok_prfpreg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9228 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
9231 /* Linux dumps the Intel SSE regs in a note named "LINUX" with a note
9232 type of NT_PRXFPREG. Just include the whole note's contents
9236 elfcore_grok_prxfpreg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9238 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-xfp", note);
9241 /* Linux dumps the Intel XSAVE extended state in a note named "LINUX"
9242 with a note type of NT_X86_XSTATE. Just include the whole note's
9243 contents literally. */
9246 elfcore_grok_xstatereg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9248 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-xstate", note);
9252 elfcore_grok_ppc_vmx (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9254 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-vmx", note);
9258 elfcore_grok_ppc_vsx (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9260 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-vsx", note);
9264 elfcore_grok_ppc_tar (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9266 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-tar", note);
9270 elfcore_grok_ppc_ppr (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9272 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-ppr", note);
9276 elfcore_grok_ppc_dscr (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9278 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-dscr", note);
9282 elfcore_grok_ppc_ebb (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9284 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-ebb", note);
9288 elfcore_grok_ppc_pmu (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9290 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-pmu", note);
9294 elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cgpr (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9296 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-tm-cgpr", note);
9300 elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cfpr (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9302 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-tm-cfpr", note);
9306 elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cvmx (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9308 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-tm-cvmx", note);
9312 elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cvsx (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9314 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-tm-cvsx", note);
9318 elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_spr (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9320 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-tm-spr", note);
9324 elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_ctar (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9326 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-tm-ctar", note);
9330 elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cppr (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9332 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-tm-cppr", note);
9336 elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cdscr (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9338 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-tm-cdscr", note);
9342 elfcore_grok_s390_high_gprs (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9344 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-high-gprs", note);
9348 elfcore_grok_s390_timer (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9350 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-timer", note);
9354 elfcore_grok_s390_todcmp (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9356 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-todcmp", note);
9360 elfcore_grok_s390_todpreg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9362 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-todpreg", note);
9366 elfcore_grok_s390_ctrs (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9368 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-ctrs", note);
9372 elfcore_grok_s390_prefix (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9374 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-prefix", note);
9378 elfcore_grok_s390_last_break (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9380 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-last-break", note);
9384 elfcore_grok_s390_system_call (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9386 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-system-call", note);
9390 elfcore_grok_s390_tdb (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9392 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-tdb", note);
9396 elfcore_grok_s390_vxrs_low (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9398 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-vxrs-low", note);
9402 elfcore_grok_s390_vxrs_high (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9404 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-vxrs-high", note);
9408 elfcore_grok_s390_gs_cb (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9410 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-gs-cb", note);
9414 elfcore_grok_s390_gs_bc (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9416 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-gs-bc", note);
9420 elfcore_grok_arm_vfp (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9422 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-arm-vfp", note);
9426 elfcore_grok_aarch_tls (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9428 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-aarch-tls", note);
9432 elfcore_grok_aarch_hw_break (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9434 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-aarch-hw-break", note);
9438 elfcore_grok_aarch_hw_watch (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9440 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-aarch-hw-watch", note);
9444 elfcore_grok_aarch_sve (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9446 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-aarch-sve", note);
9449 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T)
9450 typedef prpsinfo_t elfcore_psinfo_t;
9451 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T) /* Sparc64 cross Sparc32 */
9452 typedef prpsinfo32_t elfcore_psinfo32_t;
9456 #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
9457 typedef psinfo_t elfcore_psinfo_t;
9458 #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T) /* Sparc64 cross Sparc32 */
9459 typedef psinfo32_t elfcore_psinfo32_t;
9463 /* return a malloc'ed copy of a string at START which is at
9464 most MAX bytes long, possibly without a terminating '\0'.
9465 the copy will always have a terminating '\0'. */
9468 _bfd_elfcore_strndup (bfd *abfd, char *start, size_t max)
9471 char *end = (char *) memchr (start, '\0', max);
9479 dups = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len + 1);
9483 memcpy (dups, start, len);
9489 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
9491 elfcore_grok_psinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9493 if (note->descsz == sizeof (elfcore_psinfo_t))
9495 elfcore_psinfo_t psinfo;
9497 memcpy (&psinfo, note->descdata, sizeof (psinfo));
9499 #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T_PR_PID) || defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T_PR_PID)
9500 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = psinfo.pr_pid;
9502 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->program
9503 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_fname,
9504 sizeof (psinfo.pr_fname));
9506 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
9507 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_psargs,
9508 sizeof (psinfo.pr_psargs));
9510 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T)
9511 else if (note->descsz == sizeof (elfcore_psinfo32_t))
9513 /* 64-bit host, 32-bit corefile */
9514 elfcore_psinfo32_t psinfo;
9516 memcpy (&psinfo, note->descdata, sizeof (psinfo));
9518 #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T_PR_PID) || defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T_PR_PID)
9519 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = psinfo.pr_pid;
9521 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->program
9522 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_fname,
9523 sizeof (psinfo.pr_fname));
9525 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
9526 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_psargs,
9527 sizeof (psinfo.pr_psargs));
9533 /* Fail - we don't know how to handle any other
9534 note size (ie. data object type). */
9538 /* Note that for some reason, a spurious space is tacked
9539 onto the end of the args in some (at least one anyway)
9540 implementations, so strip it off if it exists. */
9543 char *command = elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command;
9544 int n = strlen (command);
9546 if (0 < n && command[n - 1] == ' ')
9547 command[n - 1] = '\0';
9552 #endif /* defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T) */
9554 #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T)
9556 elfcore_grok_pstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9558 if (note->descsz == sizeof (pstatus_t)
9559 #if defined (HAVE_PXSTATUS_T)
9560 || note->descsz == sizeof (pxstatus_t)
9566 memcpy (&pstat, note->descdata, sizeof (pstat));
9568 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = pstat.pr_pid;
9570 #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS32_T)
9571 else if (note->descsz == sizeof (pstatus32_t))
9573 /* 64-bit host, 32-bit corefile */
9576 memcpy (&pstat, note->descdata, sizeof (pstat));
9578 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = pstat.pr_pid;
9581 /* Could grab some more details from the "representative"
9582 lwpstatus_t in pstat.pr_lwp, but we'll catch it all in an
9583 NT_LWPSTATUS note, presumably. */
9587 #endif /* defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T) */
9589 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T)
9591 elfcore_grok_lwpstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9593 lwpstatus_t lwpstat;
9599 if (note->descsz != sizeof (lwpstat)
9600 #if defined (HAVE_LWPXSTATUS_T)
9601 && note->descsz != sizeof (lwpxstatus_t)
9606 memcpy (&lwpstat, note->descdata, sizeof (lwpstat));
9608 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = lwpstat.pr_lwpid;
9609 /* Do not overwrite the core signal if it has already been set by
9611 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal == 0)
9612 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = lwpstat.pr_cursig;
9614 /* Make a ".reg/999" section. */
9616 sprintf (buf, ".reg/%d", elfcore_make_pid (abfd));
9617 len = strlen (buf) + 1;
9618 name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
9621 memcpy (name, buf, len);
9623 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
9627 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_CONTEXT)
9628 sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs);
9629 sect->filepos = note->descpos
9630 + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs);
9633 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_REG)
9634 sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_reg);
9635 sect->filepos = note->descpos + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_reg);
9638 sect->alignment_power = 2;
9640 if (!elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".reg", sect))
9643 /* Make a ".reg2/999" section */
9645 sprintf (buf, ".reg2/%d", elfcore_make_pid (abfd));
9646 len = strlen (buf) + 1;
9647 name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
9650 memcpy (name, buf, len);
9652 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
9656 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_CONTEXT)
9657 sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.fpregs);
9658 sect->filepos = note->descpos
9659 + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_context.uc_mcontext.fpregs);
9662 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_FPREG)
9663 sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_fpreg);
9664 sect->filepos = note->descpos + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_fpreg);
9667 sect->alignment_power = 2;
9669 return elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".reg2", sect);
9671 #endif /* defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T) */
9674 elfcore_grok_win32pstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9681 int is_active_thread;
9684 if (note->descsz < 728)
9687 if (! CONST_STRNEQ (note->namedata, "win32"))
9690 type = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata);
9694 case 1 /* NOTE_INFO_PROCESS */:
9695 /* FIXME: need to add ->core->command. */
9696 /* process_info.pid */
9697 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 8);
9698 /* process_info.signal */
9699 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 12);
9702 case 2 /* NOTE_INFO_THREAD */:
9703 /* Make a ".reg/999" section. */
9704 /* thread_info.tid */
9705 sprintf (buf, ".reg/%ld", (long) bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 8));
9707 len = strlen (buf) + 1;
9708 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
9712 memcpy (name, buf, len);
9714 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
9718 /* sizeof (thread_info.thread_context) */
9720 /* offsetof (thread_info.thread_context) */
9721 sect->filepos = note->descpos + 12;
9722 sect->alignment_power = 2;
9724 /* thread_info.is_active_thread */
9725 is_active_thread = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 8);
9727 if (is_active_thread)
9728 if (! elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".reg", sect))
9732 case 3 /* NOTE_INFO_MODULE */:
9733 /* Make a ".module/xxxxxxxx" section. */
9734 /* module_info.base_address */
9735 base_addr = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 4);
9736 sprintf (buf, ".module/%08lx", (unsigned long) base_addr);
9738 len = strlen (buf) + 1;
9739 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
9743 memcpy (name, buf, len);
9745 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
9750 sect->size = note->descsz;
9751 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
9752 sect->alignment_power = 2;
9763 elfcore_grok_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9765 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
9773 if (bed->elf_backend_grok_prstatus)
9774 if ((*bed->elf_backend_grok_prstatus) (abfd, note))
9776 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T)
9777 return elfcore_grok_prstatus (abfd, note);
9782 #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T)
9784 return elfcore_grok_pstatus (abfd, note);
9787 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T)
9789 return elfcore_grok_lwpstatus (abfd, note);
9792 case NT_FPREGSET: /* FIXME: rename to NT_PRFPREG */
9793 return elfcore_grok_prfpreg (abfd, note);
9795 case NT_WIN32PSTATUS:
9796 return elfcore_grok_win32pstatus (abfd, note);
9798 case NT_PRXFPREG: /* Linux SSE extension */
9799 if (note->namesz == 6
9800 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9801 return elfcore_grok_prxfpreg (abfd, note);
9805 case NT_X86_XSTATE: /* Linux XSAVE extension */
9806 if (note->namesz == 6
9807 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9808 return elfcore_grok_xstatereg (abfd, note);
9813 if (note->namesz == 6
9814 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9815 return elfcore_grok_ppc_vmx (abfd, note);
9820 if (note->namesz == 6
9821 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9822 return elfcore_grok_ppc_vsx (abfd, note);
9827 if (note->namesz == 6
9828 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9829 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tar (abfd, note);
9834 if (note->namesz == 6
9835 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9836 return elfcore_grok_ppc_ppr (abfd, note);
9841 if (note->namesz == 6
9842 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9843 return elfcore_grok_ppc_dscr (abfd, note);
9848 if (note->namesz == 6
9849 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9850 return elfcore_grok_ppc_ebb (abfd, note);
9855 if (note->namesz == 6
9856 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9857 return elfcore_grok_ppc_pmu (abfd, note);
9861 case NT_PPC_TM_CGPR:
9862 if (note->namesz == 6
9863 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9864 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cgpr (abfd, note);
9868 case NT_PPC_TM_CFPR:
9869 if (note->namesz == 6
9870 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9871 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cfpr (abfd, note);
9875 case NT_PPC_TM_CVMX:
9876 if (note->namesz == 6
9877 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9878 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cvmx (abfd, note);
9882 case NT_PPC_TM_CVSX:
9883 if (note->namesz == 6
9884 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9885 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cvsx (abfd, note);
9890 if (note->namesz == 6
9891 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9892 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_spr (abfd, note);
9896 case NT_PPC_TM_CTAR:
9897 if (note->namesz == 6
9898 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9899 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_ctar (abfd, note);
9903 case NT_PPC_TM_CPPR:
9904 if (note->namesz == 6
9905 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9906 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cppr (abfd, note);
9910 case NT_PPC_TM_CDSCR:
9911 if (note->namesz == 6
9912 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9913 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cdscr (abfd, note);
9917 case NT_S390_HIGH_GPRS:
9918 if (note->namesz == 6
9919 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9920 return elfcore_grok_s390_high_gprs (abfd, note);
9925 if (note->namesz == 6
9926 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9927 return elfcore_grok_s390_timer (abfd, note);
9931 case NT_S390_TODCMP:
9932 if (note->namesz == 6
9933 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9934 return elfcore_grok_s390_todcmp (abfd, note);
9938 case NT_S390_TODPREG:
9939 if (note->namesz == 6
9940 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9941 return elfcore_grok_s390_todpreg (abfd, note);
9946 if (note->namesz == 6
9947 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9948 return elfcore_grok_s390_ctrs (abfd, note);
9952 case NT_S390_PREFIX:
9953 if (note->namesz == 6
9954 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9955 return elfcore_grok_s390_prefix (abfd, note);
9959 case NT_S390_LAST_BREAK:
9960 if (note->namesz == 6
9961 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9962 return elfcore_grok_s390_last_break (abfd, note);
9966 case NT_S390_SYSTEM_CALL:
9967 if (note->namesz == 6
9968 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9969 return elfcore_grok_s390_system_call (abfd, note);
9974 if (note->namesz == 6
9975 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9976 return elfcore_grok_s390_tdb (abfd, note);
9980 case NT_S390_VXRS_LOW:
9981 if (note->namesz == 6
9982 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9983 return elfcore_grok_s390_vxrs_low (abfd, note);
9987 case NT_S390_VXRS_HIGH:
9988 if (note->namesz == 6
9989 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9990 return elfcore_grok_s390_vxrs_high (abfd, note);
9995 if (note->namesz == 6
9996 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9997 return elfcore_grok_s390_gs_cb (abfd, note);
10001 case NT_S390_GS_BC:
10002 if (note->namesz == 6
10003 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10004 return elfcore_grok_s390_gs_bc (abfd, note);
10009 if (note->namesz == 6
10010 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10011 return elfcore_grok_arm_vfp (abfd, note);
10016 if (note->namesz == 6
10017 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10018 return elfcore_grok_aarch_tls (abfd, note);
10022 case NT_ARM_HW_BREAK:
10023 if (note->namesz == 6
10024 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10025 return elfcore_grok_aarch_hw_break (abfd, note);
10029 case NT_ARM_HW_WATCH:
10030 if (note->namesz == 6
10031 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10032 return elfcore_grok_aarch_hw_watch (abfd, note);
10037 if (note->namesz == 6
10038 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10039 return elfcore_grok_aarch_sve (abfd, note);
10045 if (bed->elf_backend_grok_psinfo)
10046 if ((*bed->elf_backend_grok_psinfo) (abfd, note))
10048 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
10049 return elfcore_grok_psinfo (abfd, note);
10056 asection *sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".auxv",
10061 sect->size = note->descsz;
10062 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
10063 sect->alignment_power = 1 + bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 32;
10069 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.linuxcore.file",
10073 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.linuxcore.siginfo",
10080 elfobj_grok_gnu_build_id (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10082 struct bfd_build_id* build_id;
10084 if (note->descsz == 0)
10087 build_id = bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof (struct bfd_build_id) - 1 + note->descsz);
10088 if (build_id == NULL)
10091 build_id->size = note->descsz;
10092 memcpy (build_id->data, note->descdata, note->descsz);
10093 abfd->build_id = build_id;
10099 elfobj_grok_gnu_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10101 switch (note->type)
10106 case NT_GNU_PROPERTY_TYPE_0:
10107 return _bfd_elf_parse_gnu_properties (abfd, note);
10109 case NT_GNU_BUILD_ID:
10110 return elfobj_grok_gnu_build_id (abfd, note);
10115 elfobj_grok_stapsdt_note_1 (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10117 struct sdt_note *cur =
10118 (struct sdt_note *) bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof (struct sdt_note)
10121 cur->next = (struct sdt_note *) (elf_tdata (abfd))->sdt_note_head;
10122 cur->size = (bfd_size_type) note->descsz;
10123 memcpy (cur->data, note->descdata, note->descsz);
10125 elf_tdata (abfd)->sdt_note_head = cur;
10131 elfobj_grok_stapsdt_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10133 switch (note->type)
10136 return elfobj_grok_stapsdt_note_1 (abfd, note);
10144 elfcore_grok_freebsd_psinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10148 switch (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS])
10151 if (note->descsz < 108)
10156 if (note->descsz < 120)
10164 /* Check for version 1 in pr_version. */
10165 if (bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata) != 1)
10170 /* Skip over pr_psinfosz. */
10171 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS] == ELFCLASS32)
10175 offset += 4; /* Padding before pr_psinfosz. */
10179 /* pr_fname is PRFNAMESZ (16) + 1 bytes in size. */
10180 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->program
10181 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + offset, 17);
10184 /* pr_psargs is PRARGSZ (80) + 1 bytes in size. */
10185 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
10186 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + offset, 81);
10189 /* Padding before pr_pid. */
10192 /* The pr_pid field was added in version "1a". */
10193 if (note->descsz < offset + 4)
10196 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid
10197 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + offset);
10203 elfcore_grok_freebsd_prstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10209 /* Compute offset of pr_getregsz, skipping over pr_statussz.
10210 Also compute minimum size of this note. */
10211 switch (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS])
10215 min_size = offset + (4 * 2) + 4 + 4 + 4;
10219 offset = 4 + 4 + 8; /* Includes padding before pr_statussz. */
10220 min_size = offset + (8 * 2) + 4 + 4 + 4 + 4;
10227 if (note->descsz < min_size)
10230 /* Check for version 1 in pr_version. */
10231 if (bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata) != 1)
10234 /* Extract size of pr_reg from pr_gregsetsz. */
10235 /* Skip over pr_gregsetsz and pr_fpregsetsz. */
10236 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS] == ELFCLASS32)
10238 size = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + offset);
10243 size = bfd_h_get_64 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + offset);
10247 /* Skip over pr_osreldate. */
10250 /* Read signal from pr_cursig. */
10251 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal == 0)
10252 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal
10253 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + offset);
10256 /* Read TID from pr_pid. */
10257 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid
10258 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + offset);
10261 /* Padding before pr_reg. */
10262 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS] == ELFCLASS64)
10265 /* Make sure that there is enough data remaining in the note. */
10266 if ((note->descsz - offset) < size)
10269 /* Make a ".reg/999" section and a ".reg" section. */
10270 return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg",
10271 size, note->descpos + offset);
10275 elfcore_grok_freebsd_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10277 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
10279 switch (note->type)
10282 if (bed->elf_backend_grok_freebsd_prstatus)
10283 if ((*bed->elf_backend_grok_freebsd_prstatus) (abfd, note))
10285 return elfcore_grok_freebsd_prstatus (abfd, note);
10288 return elfcore_grok_prfpreg (abfd, note);
10291 return elfcore_grok_freebsd_psinfo (abfd, note);
10293 case NT_FREEBSD_THRMISC:
10294 if (note->namesz == 8)
10295 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".thrmisc", note);
10299 case NT_FREEBSD_PROCSTAT_PROC:
10300 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.freebsdcore.proc",
10303 case NT_FREEBSD_PROCSTAT_FILES:
10304 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.freebsdcore.files",
10307 case NT_FREEBSD_PROCSTAT_VMMAP:
10308 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.freebsdcore.vmmap",
10311 case NT_FREEBSD_PROCSTAT_AUXV:
10313 asection *sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".auxv",
10318 sect->size = note->descsz - 4;
10319 sect->filepos = note->descpos + 4;
10320 sect->alignment_power = 1 + bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 32;
10325 case NT_X86_XSTATE:
10326 if (note->namesz == 8)
10327 return elfcore_grok_xstatereg (abfd, note);
10331 case NT_FREEBSD_PTLWPINFO:
10332 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.freebsdcore.lwpinfo",
10336 return elfcore_grok_arm_vfp (abfd, note);
10344 elfcore_netbsd_get_lwpid (Elf_Internal_Note *note, int *lwpidp)
10348 cp = strchr (note->namedata, '@');
10351 *lwpidp = atoi(cp + 1);
10358 elfcore_grok_netbsd_procinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10360 if (note->descsz <= 0x7c + 31)
10363 /* Signal number at offset 0x08. */
10364 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal
10365 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x08);
10367 /* Process ID at offset 0x50. */
10368 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid
10369 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x50);
10371 /* Command name at 0x7c (max 32 bytes, including nul). */
10372 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
10373 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 0x7c, 31);
10375 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.netbsdcore.procinfo",
10380 elfcore_grok_netbsd_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10384 if (elfcore_netbsd_get_lwpid (note, &lwp))
10385 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = lwp;
10387 if (note->type == NT_NETBSDCORE_PROCINFO)
10389 /* NetBSD-specific core "procinfo". Note that we expect to
10390 find this note before any of the others, which is fine,
10391 since the kernel writes this note out first when it
10392 creates a core file. */
10394 return elfcore_grok_netbsd_procinfo (abfd, note);
10397 /* As of Jan 2002 there are no other machine-independent notes
10398 defined for NetBSD core files. If the note type is less
10399 than the start of the machine-dependent note types, we don't
10402 if (note->type < NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH)
10406 switch (bfd_get_arch (abfd))
10408 /* On the Alpha, SPARC (32-bit and 64-bit), PT_GETREGS == mach+0 and
10409 PT_GETFPREGS == mach+2. */
10411 case bfd_arch_alpha:
10412 case bfd_arch_sparc:
10413 switch (note->type)
10415 case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+0:
10416 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg", note);
10418 case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+2:
10419 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
10425 /* On all other arch's, PT_GETREGS == mach+1 and
10426 PT_GETFPREGS == mach+3. */
10429 switch (note->type)
10431 case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+1:
10432 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg", note);
10434 case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+3:
10435 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
10445 elfcore_grok_openbsd_procinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10447 if (note->descsz <= 0x48 + 31)
10450 /* Signal number at offset 0x08. */
10451 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal
10452 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x08);
10454 /* Process ID at offset 0x20. */
10455 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid
10456 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x20);
10458 /* Command name at 0x48 (max 32 bytes, including nul). */
10459 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
10460 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 0x48, 31);
10466 elfcore_grok_openbsd_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10468 if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_PROCINFO)
10469 return elfcore_grok_openbsd_procinfo (abfd, note);
10471 if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_REGS)
10472 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg", note);
10474 if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_FPREGS)
10475 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
10477 if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_XFPREGS)
10478 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-xfp", note);
10480 if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_AUXV)
10482 asection *sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".auxv",
10487 sect->size = note->descsz;
10488 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
10489 sect->alignment_power = 1 + bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 32;
10494 if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_WCOOKIE)
10496 asection *sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".wcookie",
10501 sect->size = note->descsz;
10502 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
10503 sect->alignment_power = 1 + bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 32;
10512 elfcore_grok_nto_status (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note, long *tid)
10514 void *ddata = note->descdata;
10521 if (note->descsz < 16)
10524 /* nto_procfs_status 'pid' field is at offset 0. */
10525 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata);
10527 /* nto_procfs_status 'tid' field is at offset 4. Pass it back. */
10528 *tid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata + 4);
10530 /* nto_procfs_status 'flags' field is at offset 8. */
10531 flags = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata + 8);
10533 /* nto_procfs_status 'what' field is at offset 14. */
10534 if ((sig = bfd_get_16 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata + 14)) > 0)
10536 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = sig;
10537 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = *tid;
10540 /* _DEBUG_FLAG_CURTID (current thread) is 0x80. Some cores
10541 do not come from signals so we make sure we set the current
10542 thread just in case. */
10543 if (flags & 0x00000080)
10544 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = *tid;
10546 /* Make a ".qnx_core_status/%d" section. */
10547 sprintf (buf, ".qnx_core_status/%ld", *tid);
10549 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, strlen (buf) + 1);
10552 strcpy (name, buf);
10554 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
10558 sect->size = note->descsz;
10559 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
10560 sect->alignment_power = 2;
10562 return (elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".qnx_core_status", sect));
10566 elfcore_grok_nto_regs (bfd *abfd,
10567 Elf_Internal_Note *note,
10575 /* Make a "(base)/%d" section. */
10576 sprintf (buf, "%s/%ld", base, tid);
10578 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, strlen (buf) + 1);
10581 strcpy (name, buf);
10583 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
10587 sect->size = note->descsz;
10588 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
10589 sect->alignment_power = 2;
10591 /* This is the current thread. */
10592 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid == tid)
10593 return elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, base, sect);
10598 #define BFD_QNT_CORE_INFO 7
10599 #define BFD_QNT_CORE_STATUS 8
10600 #define BFD_QNT_CORE_GREG 9
10601 #define BFD_QNT_CORE_FPREG 10
10604 elfcore_grok_nto_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10606 /* Every GREG section has a STATUS section before it. Store the
10607 tid from the previous call to pass down to the next gregs
10609 static long tid = 1;
10611 switch (note->type)
10613 case BFD_QNT_CORE_INFO:
10614 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".qnx_core_info", note);
10615 case BFD_QNT_CORE_STATUS:
10616 return elfcore_grok_nto_status (abfd, note, &tid);
10617 case BFD_QNT_CORE_GREG:
10618 return elfcore_grok_nto_regs (abfd, note, tid, ".reg");
10619 case BFD_QNT_CORE_FPREG:
10620 return elfcore_grok_nto_regs (abfd, note, tid, ".reg2");
10627 elfcore_grok_spu_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10633 /* Use note name as section name. */
10634 len = note->namesz;
10635 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
10638 memcpy (name, note->namedata, len);
10639 name[len - 1] = '\0';
10641 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
10645 sect->size = note->descsz;
10646 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
10647 sect->alignment_power = 1;
10652 /* Function: elfcore_write_note
10655 buffer to hold note, and current size of buffer
10659 size of data for note
10661 Writes note to end of buffer. ELF64 notes are written exactly as
10662 for ELF32, despite the current (as of 2006) ELF gabi specifying
10663 that they ought to have 8-byte namesz and descsz field, and have
10664 8-byte alignment. Other writers, eg. Linux kernel, do the same.
10667 Pointer to realloc'd buffer, *BUFSIZ updated. */
10670 elfcore_write_note (bfd *abfd,
10678 Elf_External_Note *xnp;
10685 namesz = strlen (name) + 1;
10687 newspace = 12 + ((namesz + 3) & -4) + ((size + 3) & -4);
10689 buf = (char *) realloc (buf, *bufsiz + newspace);
10692 dest = buf + *bufsiz;
10693 *bufsiz += newspace;
10694 xnp = (Elf_External_Note *) dest;
10695 H_PUT_32 (abfd, namesz, xnp->namesz);
10696 H_PUT_32 (abfd, size, xnp->descsz);
10697 H_PUT_32 (abfd, type, xnp->type);
10701 memcpy (dest, name, namesz);
10709 memcpy (dest, input, size);
10719 /* gcc-8 warns (*) on all the strncpy calls in this function about
10720 possible string truncation. The "truncation" is not a bug. We
10721 have an external representation of structs with fields that are not
10722 necessarily NULL terminated and corresponding internal
10723 representation fields that are one larger so that they can always
10724 be NULL terminated.
10725 gcc versions between 4.2 and 4.6 do not allow pragma control of
10726 diagnostics inside functions, giving a hard error if you try to use
10727 the finer control available with later versions.
10728 gcc prior to 4.2 warns about diagnostic push and pop.
10729 gcc-5, gcc-6 and gcc-7 warn that -Wstringop-truncation is unknown,
10730 unless you also add #pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wpragma".
10731 (*) Depending on your system header files! */
10732 #if GCC_VERSION >= 8000
10733 # pragma GCC diagnostic push
10734 # pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wstringop-truncation"
10737 elfcore_write_prpsinfo (bfd *abfd,
10741 const char *psargs)
10743 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
10745 if (bed->elf_backend_write_core_note != NULL)
10748 ret = (*bed->elf_backend_write_core_note) (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10749 NT_PRPSINFO, fname, psargs);
10754 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
10755 # if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T)
10756 if (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS32)
10758 # if defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T)
10760 int note_type = NT_PSINFO;
10763 int note_type = NT_PRPSINFO;
10766 memset (&data, 0, sizeof (data));
10767 strncpy (data.pr_fname, fname, sizeof (data.pr_fname));
10768 strncpy (data.pr_psargs, psargs, sizeof (data.pr_psargs));
10769 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10770 "CORE", note_type, &data, sizeof (data));
10775 # if defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
10777 int note_type = NT_PSINFO;
10780 int note_type = NT_PRPSINFO;
10783 memset (&data, 0, sizeof (data));
10784 strncpy (data.pr_fname, fname, sizeof (data.pr_fname));
10785 strncpy (data.pr_psargs, psargs, sizeof (data.pr_psargs));
10786 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10787 "CORE", note_type, &data, sizeof (data));
10789 #endif /* PSINFO_T or PRPSINFO_T */
10794 #if GCC_VERSION >= 8000
10795 # pragma GCC diagnostic pop
10799 elfcore_write_linux_prpsinfo32
10800 (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz,
10801 const struct elf_internal_linux_prpsinfo *prpsinfo)
10803 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->linux_prpsinfo32_ugid16)
10805 struct elf_external_linux_prpsinfo32_ugid16 data;
10807 swap_linux_prpsinfo32_ugid16_out (abfd, prpsinfo, &data);
10808 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, "CORE", NT_PRPSINFO,
10809 &data, sizeof (data));
10813 struct elf_external_linux_prpsinfo32_ugid32 data;
10815 swap_linux_prpsinfo32_ugid32_out (abfd, prpsinfo, &data);
10816 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, "CORE", NT_PRPSINFO,
10817 &data, sizeof (data));
10822 elfcore_write_linux_prpsinfo64
10823 (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz,
10824 const struct elf_internal_linux_prpsinfo *prpsinfo)
10826 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->linux_prpsinfo64_ugid16)
10828 struct elf_external_linux_prpsinfo64_ugid16 data;
10830 swap_linux_prpsinfo64_ugid16_out (abfd, prpsinfo, &data);
10831 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10832 "CORE", NT_PRPSINFO, &data, sizeof (data));
10836 struct elf_external_linux_prpsinfo64_ugid32 data;
10838 swap_linux_prpsinfo64_ugid32_out (abfd, prpsinfo, &data);
10839 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10840 "CORE", NT_PRPSINFO, &data, sizeof (data));
10845 elfcore_write_prstatus (bfd *abfd,
10852 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
10854 if (bed->elf_backend_write_core_note != NULL)
10857 ret = (*bed->elf_backend_write_core_note) (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10859 pid, cursig, gregs);
10864 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T)
10865 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T)
10866 if (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS32)
10868 prstatus32_t prstat;
10870 memset (&prstat, 0, sizeof (prstat));
10871 prstat.pr_pid = pid;
10872 prstat.pr_cursig = cursig;
10873 memcpy (&prstat.pr_reg, gregs, sizeof (prstat.pr_reg));
10874 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, "CORE",
10875 NT_PRSTATUS, &prstat, sizeof (prstat));
10882 memset (&prstat, 0, sizeof (prstat));
10883 prstat.pr_pid = pid;
10884 prstat.pr_cursig = cursig;
10885 memcpy (&prstat.pr_reg, gregs, sizeof (prstat.pr_reg));
10886 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, "CORE",
10887 NT_PRSTATUS, &prstat, sizeof (prstat));
10889 #endif /* HAVE_PRSTATUS_T */
10895 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T)
10897 elfcore_write_lwpstatus (bfd *abfd,
10904 lwpstatus_t lwpstat;
10905 const char *note_name = "CORE";
10907 memset (&lwpstat, 0, sizeof (lwpstat));
10908 lwpstat.pr_lwpid = pid >> 16;
10909 lwpstat.pr_cursig = cursig;
10910 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_REG)
10911 memcpy (&lwpstat.pr_reg, gregs, sizeof (lwpstat.pr_reg));
10912 #elif defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_CONTEXT)
10913 #if !defined(gregs)
10914 memcpy (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs,
10915 gregs, sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs));
10917 memcpy (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.__gregs,
10918 gregs, sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.__gregs));
10921 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, note_name,
10922 NT_LWPSTATUS, &lwpstat, sizeof (lwpstat));
10924 #endif /* HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T */
10926 #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T)
10928 elfcore_write_pstatus (bfd *abfd,
10932 int cursig ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
10933 const void *gregs ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
10935 const char *note_name = "CORE";
10936 #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS32_T)
10937 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
10939 if (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS32)
10943 memset (&pstat, 0, sizeof (pstat));
10944 pstat.pr_pid = pid & 0xffff;
10945 buf = elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, note_name,
10946 NT_PSTATUS, &pstat, sizeof (pstat));
10954 memset (&pstat, 0, sizeof (pstat));
10955 pstat.pr_pid = pid & 0xffff;
10956 buf = elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, note_name,
10957 NT_PSTATUS, &pstat, sizeof (pstat));
10961 #endif /* HAVE_PSTATUS_T */
10964 elfcore_write_prfpreg (bfd *abfd,
10967 const void *fpregs,
10970 const char *note_name = "CORE";
10971 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10972 note_name, NT_FPREGSET, fpregs, size);
10976 elfcore_write_prxfpreg (bfd *abfd,
10979 const void *xfpregs,
10982 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10983 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10984 note_name, NT_PRXFPREG, xfpregs, size);
10988 elfcore_write_xstatereg (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz,
10989 const void *xfpregs, int size)
10992 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_osabi == ELFOSABI_FREEBSD)
10993 note_name = "FreeBSD";
10995 note_name = "LINUX";
10996 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10997 note_name, NT_X86_XSTATE, xfpregs, size);
11001 elfcore_write_ppc_vmx (bfd *abfd,
11004 const void *ppc_vmx,
11007 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11008 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11009 note_name, NT_PPC_VMX, ppc_vmx, size);
11013 elfcore_write_ppc_vsx (bfd *abfd,
11016 const void *ppc_vsx,
11019 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11020 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11021 note_name, NT_PPC_VSX, ppc_vsx, size);
11025 elfcore_write_ppc_tar (bfd *abfd,
11028 const void *ppc_tar,
11031 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11032 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11033 note_name, NT_PPC_TAR, ppc_tar, size);
11037 elfcore_write_ppc_ppr (bfd *abfd,
11040 const void *ppc_ppr,
11043 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11044 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11045 note_name, NT_PPC_PPR, ppc_ppr, size);
11049 elfcore_write_ppc_dscr (bfd *abfd,
11052 const void *ppc_dscr,
11055 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11056 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11057 note_name, NT_PPC_DSCR, ppc_dscr, size);
11061 elfcore_write_ppc_ebb (bfd *abfd,
11064 const void *ppc_ebb,
11067 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11068 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11069 note_name, NT_PPC_EBB, ppc_ebb, size);
11073 elfcore_write_ppc_pmu (bfd *abfd,
11076 const void *ppc_pmu,
11079 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11080 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11081 note_name, NT_PPC_PMU, ppc_pmu, size);
11085 elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cgpr (bfd *abfd,
11088 const void *ppc_tm_cgpr,
11091 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11092 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11093 note_name, NT_PPC_TM_CGPR, ppc_tm_cgpr, size);
11097 elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cfpr (bfd *abfd,
11100 const void *ppc_tm_cfpr,
11103 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11104 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11105 note_name, NT_PPC_TM_CFPR, ppc_tm_cfpr, size);
11109 elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cvmx (bfd *abfd,
11112 const void *ppc_tm_cvmx,
11115 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11116 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11117 note_name, NT_PPC_TM_CVMX, ppc_tm_cvmx, size);
11121 elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cvsx (bfd *abfd,
11124 const void *ppc_tm_cvsx,
11127 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11128 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11129 note_name, NT_PPC_TM_CVSX, ppc_tm_cvsx, size);
11133 elfcore_write_ppc_tm_spr (bfd *abfd,
11136 const void *ppc_tm_spr,
11139 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11140 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11141 note_name, NT_PPC_TM_SPR, ppc_tm_spr, size);
11145 elfcore_write_ppc_tm_ctar (bfd *abfd,
11148 const void *ppc_tm_ctar,
11151 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11152 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11153 note_name, NT_PPC_TM_CTAR, ppc_tm_ctar, size);
11157 elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cppr (bfd *abfd,
11160 const void *ppc_tm_cppr,
11163 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11164 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11165 note_name, NT_PPC_TM_CPPR, ppc_tm_cppr, size);
11169 elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cdscr (bfd *abfd,
11172 const void *ppc_tm_cdscr,
11175 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11176 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11177 note_name, NT_PPC_TM_CDSCR, ppc_tm_cdscr, size);
11181 elfcore_write_s390_high_gprs (bfd *abfd,
11184 const void *s390_high_gprs,
11187 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11188 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11189 note_name, NT_S390_HIGH_GPRS,
11190 s390_high_gprs, size);
11194 elfcore_write_s390_timer (bfd *abfd,
11197 const void *s390_timer,
11200 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11201 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11202 note_name, NT_S390_TIMER, s390_timer, size);
11206 elfcore_write_s390_todcmp (bfd *abfd,
11209 const void *s390_todcmp,
11212 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11213 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11214 note_name, NT_S390_TODCMP, s390_todcmp, size);
11218 elfcore_write_s390_todpreg (bfd *abfd,
11221 const void *s390_todpreg,
11224 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11225 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11226 note_name, NT_S390_TODPREG, s390_todpreg, size);
11230 elfcore_write_s390_ctrs (bfd *abfd,
11233 const void *s390_ctrs,
11236 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11237 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11238 note_name, NT_S390_CTRS, s390_ctrs, size);
11242 elfcore_write_s390_prefix (bfd *abfd,
11245 const void *s390_prefix,
11248 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11249 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11250 note_name, NT_S390_PREFIX, s390_prefix, size);
11254 elfcore_write_s390_last_break (bfd *abfd,
11257 const void *s390_last_break,
11260 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11261 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11262 note_name, NT_S390_LAST_BREAK,
11263 s390_last_break, size);
11267 elfcore_write_s390_system_call (bfd *abfd,
11270 const void *s390_system_call,
11273 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11274 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11275 note_name, NT_S390_SYSTEM_CALL,
11276 s390_system_call, size);
11280 elfcore_write_s390_tdb (bfd *abfd,
11283 const void *s390_tdb,
11286 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11287 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11288 note_name, NT_S390_TDB, s390_tdb, size);
11292 elfcore_write_s390_vxrs_low (bfd *abfd,
11295 const void *s390_vxrs_low,
11298 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11299 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11300 note_name, NT_S390_VXRS_LOW, s390_vxrs_low, size);
11304 elfcore_write_s390_vxrs_high (bfd *abfd,
11307 const void *s390_vxrs_high,
11310 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11311 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11312 note_name, NT_S390_VXRS_HIGH,
11313 s390_vxrs_high, size);
11317 elfcore_write_s390_gs_cb (bfd *abfd,
11320 const void *s390_gs_cb,
11323 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11324 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11325 note_name, NT_S390_GS_CB,
11330 elfcore_write_s390_gs_bc (bfd *abfd,
11333 const void *s390_gs_bc,
11336 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11337 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11338 note_name, NT_S390_GS_BC,
11343 elfcore_write_arm_vfp (bfd *abfd,
11346 const void *arm_vfp,
11349 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11350 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11351 note_name, NT_ARM_VFP, arm_vfp, size);
11355 elfcore_write_aarch_tls (bfd *abfd,
11358 const void *aarch_tls,
11361 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11362 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11363 note_name, NT_ARM_TLS, aarch_tls, size);
11367 elfcore_write_aarch_hw_break (bfd *abfd,
11370 const void *aarch_hw_break,
11373 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11374 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11375 note_name, NT_ARM_HW_BREAK, aarch_hw_break, size);
11379 elfcore_write_aarch_hw_watch (bfd *abfd,
11382 const void *aarch_hw_watch,
11385 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11386 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11387 note_name, NT_ARM_HW_WATCH, aarch_hw_watch, size);
11391 elfcore_write_aarch_sve (bfd *abfd,
11394 const void *aarch_sve,
11397 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11398 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11399 note_name, NT_ARM_SVE, aarch_sve, size);
11403 elfcore_write_register_note (bfd *abfd,
11406 const char *section,
11410 if (strcmp (section, ".reg2") == 0)
11411 return elfcore_write_prfpreg (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11412 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-xfp") == 0)
11413 return elfcore_write_prxfpreg (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11414 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-xstate") == 0)
11415 return elfcore_write_xstatereg (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11416 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-vmx") == 0)
11417 return elfcore_write_ppc_vmx (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11418 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-vsx") == 0)
11419 return elfcore_write_ppc_vsx (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11420 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-tar") == 0)
11421 return elfcore_write_ppc_tar (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11422 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-ppr") == 0)
11423 return elfcore_write_ppc_ppr (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11424 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-dscr") == 0)
11425 return elfcore_write_ppc_dscr (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11426 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-ebb") == 0)
11427 return elfcore_write_ppc_ebb (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11428 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-pmu") == 0)
11429 return elfcore_write_ppc_pmu (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11430 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-tm-cgpr") == 0)
11431 return elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cgpr (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11432 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-tm-cfpr") == 0)
11433 return elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cfpr (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11434 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-tm-cvmx") == 0)
11435 return elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cvmx (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11436 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-tm-cvsx") == 0)
11437 return elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cvsx (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11438 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-tm-spr") == 0)
11439 return elfcore_write_ppc_tm_spr (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11440 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-tm-ctar") == 0)
11441 return elfcore_write_ppc_tm_ctar (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11442 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-tm-cppr") == 0)
11443 return elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cppr (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11444 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-tm-cdscr") == 0)
11445 return elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cdscr (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11446 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-high-gprs") == 0)
11447 return elfcore_write_s390_high_gprs (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11448 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-timer") == 0)
11449 return elfcore_write_s390_timer (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11450 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-todcmp") == 0)
11451 return elfcore_write_s390_todcmp (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11452 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-todpreg") == 0)
11453 return elfcore_write_s390_todpreg (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11454 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-ctrs") == 0)
11455 return elfcore_write_s390_ctrs (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11456 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-prefix") == 0)
11457 return elfcore_write_s390_prefix (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11458 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-last-break") == 0)
11459 return elfcore_write_s390_last_break (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11460 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-system-call") == 0)
11461 return elfcore_write_s390_system_call (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11462 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-tdb") == 0)
11463 return elfcore_write_s390_tdb (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11464 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-vxrs-low") == 0)
11465 return elfcore_write_s390_vxrs_low (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11466 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-vxrs-high") == 0)
11467 return elfcore_write_s390_vxrs_high (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11468 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-gs-cb") == 0)
11469 return elfcore_write_s390_gs_cb (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11470 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-gs-bc") == 0)
11471 return elfcore_write_s390_gs_bc (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11472 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-arm-vfp") == 0)
11473 return elfcore_write_arm_vfp (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11474 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-aarch-tls") == 0)
11475 return elfcore_write_aarch_tls (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11476 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-aarch-hw-break") == 0)
11477 return elfcore_write_aarch_hw_break (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11478 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-aarch-hw-watch") == 0)
11479 return elfcore_write_aarch_hw_watch (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11480 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-aarch-sve") == 0)
11481 return elfcore_write_aarch_sve (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11486 elf_parse_notes (bfd *abfd, char *buf, size_t size, file_ptr offset,
11491 /* NB: CORE PT_NOTE segments may have p_align values of 0 or 1.
11492 gABI specifies that PT_NOTE alignment should be aligned to 4
11493 bytes for 32-bit objects and to 8 bytes for 64-bit objects. If
11494 align is less than 4, we use 4 byte alignment. */
11497 if (align != 4 && align != 8)
11501 while (p < buf + size)
11503 Elf_External_Note *xnp = (Elf_External_Note *) p;
11504 Elf_Internal_Note in;
11506 if (offsetof (Elf_External_Note, name) > buf - p + size)
11509 in.type = H_GET_32 (abfd, xnp->type);
11511 in.namesz = H_GET_32 (abfd, xnp->namesz);
11512 in.namedata = xnp->name;
11513 if (in.namesz > buf - in.namedata + size)
11516 in.descsz = H_GET_32 (abfd, xnp->descsz);
11517 in.descdata = p + ELF_NOTE_DESC_OFFSET (in.namesz, align);
11518 in.descpos = offset + (in.descdata - buf);
11520 && (in.descdata >= buf + size
11521 || in.descsz > buf - in.descdata + size))
11524 switch (bfd_get_format (abfd))
11531 #define GROKER_ELEMENT(S,F) {S, sizeof (S) - 1, F}
11534 const char * string;
11536 bfd_boolean (* func)(bfd *, Elf_Internal_Note *);
11540 GROKER_ELEMENT ("", elfcore_grok_note),
11541 GROKER_ELEMENT ("FreeBSD", elfcore_grok_freebsd_note),
11542 GROKER_ELEMENT ("NetBSD-CORE", elfcore_grok_netbsd_note),
11543 GROKER_ELEMENT ( "OpenBSD", elfcore_grok_openbsd_note),
11544 GROKER_ELEMENT ("QNX", elfcore_grok_nto_note),
11545 GROKER_ELEMENT ("SPU/", elfcore_grok_spu_note)
11547 #undef GROKER_ELEMENT
11550 for (i = ARRAY_SIZE (grokers); i--;)
11552 if (in.namesz >= grokers[i].len
11553 && strncmp (in.namedata, grokers[i].string,
11554 grokers[i].len) == 0)
11556 if (! grokers[i].func (abfd, & in))
11565 if (in.namesz == sizeof "GNU" && strcmp (in.namedata, "GNU") == 0)
11567 if (! elfobj_grok_gnu_note (abfd, &in))
11570 else if (in.namesz == sizeof "stapsdt"
11571 && strcmp (in.namedata, "stapsdt") == 0)
11573 if (! elfobj_grok_stapsdt_note (abfd, &in))
11579 p += ELF_NOTE_NEXT_OFFSET (in.namesz, in.descsz, align);
11586 elf_read_notes (bfd *abfd, file_ptr offset, bfd_size_type size,
11591 if (size == 0 || (size + 1) == 0)
11594 if (bfd_seek (abfd, offset, SEEK_SET) != 0)
11597 buf = (char *) bfd_malloc (size + 1);
11601 /* PR 17512: file: ec08f814
11602 0-termintate the buffer so that string searches will not overflow. */
11605 if (bfd_bread (buf, size, abfd) != size
11606 || !elf_parse_notes (abfd, buf, size, offset, align))
11616 /* Providing external access to the ELF program header table. */
11618 /* Return an upper bound on the number of bytes required to store a
11619 copy of ABFD's program header table entries. Return -1 if an error
11620 occurs; bfd_get_error will return an appropriate code. */
11623 bfd_get_elf_phdr_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
11625 if (abfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
11627 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_wrong_format);
11631 return elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum * sizeof (Elf_Internal_Phdr);
11634 /* Copy ABFD's program header table entries to *PHDRS. The entries
11635 will be stored as an array of Elf_Internal_Phdr structures, as
11636 defined in include/elf/internal.h. To find out how large the
11637 buffer needs to be, call bfd_get_elf_phdr_upper_bound.
11639 Return the number of program header table entries read, or -1 if an
11640 error occurs; bfd_get_error will return an appropriate code. */
11643 bfd_get_elf_phdrs (bfd *abfd, void *phdrs)
11647 if (abfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
11649 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_wrong_format);
11653 num_phdrs = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum;
11654 if (num_phdrs != 0)
11655 memcpy (phdrs, elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr,
11656 num_phdrs * sizeof (Elf_Internal_Phdr));
11661 enum elf_reloc_type_class
11662 _bfd_elf_reloc_type_class (const struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
11663 const asection *rel_sec ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
11664 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rela ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
11666 return reloc_class_normal;
11669 /* For RELA architectures, return the relocation value for a
11670 relocation against a local symbol. */
11673 _bfd_elf_rela_local_sym (bfd *abfd,
11674 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
11676 Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
11678 asection *sec = *psec;
11679 bfd_vma relocation;
11681 relocation = (sec->output_section->vma
11682 + sec->output_offset
11684 if ((sec->flags & SEC_MERGE)
11685 && ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_SECTION
11686 && sec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_MERGE)
11689 _bfd_merged_section_offset (abfd, psec,
11690 elf_section_data (sec)->sec_info,
11691 sym->st_value + rel->r_addend);
11694 /* If we have changed the section, and our original section is
11695 marked with SEC_EXCLUDE, it means that the original
11696 SEC_MERGE section has been completely subsumed in some
11697 other SEC_MERGE section. In this case, we need to leave
11698 some info around for --emit-relocs. */
11699 if ((sec->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) != 0)
11700 sec->kept_section = *psec;
11703 rel->r_addend -= relocation;
11704 rel->r_addend += sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
11710 _bfd_elf_rel_local_sym (bfd *abfd,
11711 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
11715 asection *sec = *psec;
11717 if (sec->sec_info_type != SEC_INFO_TYPE_MERGE)
11718 return sym->st_value + addend;
11720 return _bfd_merged_section_offset (abfd, psec,
11721 elf_section_data (sec)->sec_info,
11722 sym->st_value + addend);
11725 /* Adjust an address within a section. Given OFFSET within SEC, return
11726 the new offset within the section, based upon changes made to the
11727 section. Returns -1 if the offset is now invalid.
11728 The offset (in abnd out) is in target sized bytes, however big a
11732 _bfd_elf_section_offset (bfd *abfd,
11733 struct bfd_link_info *info,
11737 switch (sec->sec_info_type)
11739 case SEC_INFO_TYPE_STABS:
11740 return _bfd_stab_section_offset (sec, elf_section_data (sec)->sec_info,
11742 case SEC_INFO_TYPE_EH_FRAME:
11743 return _bfd_elf_eh_frame_section_offset (abfd, info, sec, offset);
11746 if ((sec->flags & SEC_ELF_REVERSE_COPY) != 0)
11748 /* Reverse the offset. */
11749 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
11750 bfd_size_type address_size = bed->s->arch_size / 8;
11752 /* address_size and sec->size are in octets. Convert
11753 to bytes before subtracting the original offset. */
11754 offset = (sec->size - address_size) / bfd_octets_per_byte (abfd) - offset;
11760 /* Create a new BFD as if by bfd_openr. Rather than opening a file,
11761 reconstruct an ELF file by reading the segments out of remote memory
11762 based on the ELF file header at EHDR_VMA and the ELF program headers it
11763 points to. If not null, *LOADBASEP is filled in with the difference
11764 between the VMAs from which the segments were read, and the VMAs the
11765 file headers (and hence BFD's idea of each section's VMA) put them at.
11767 The function TARGET_READ_MEMORY is called to copy LEN bytes from the
11768 remote memory at target address VMA into the local buffer at MYADDR; it
11769 should return zero on success or an `errno' code on failure. TEMPL must
11770 be a BFD for an ELF target with the word size and byte order found in
11771 the remote memory. */
11774 bfd_elf_bfd_from_remote_memory
11777 bfd_size_type size,
11778 bfd_vma *loadbasep,
11779 int (*target_read_memory) (bfd_vma, bfd_byte *, bfd_size_type))
11781 return (*get_elf_backend_data (templ)->elf_backend_bfd_from_remote_memory)
11782 (templ, ehdr_vma, size, loadbasep, target_read_memory);
11786 _bfd_elf_get_synthetic_symtab (bfd *abfd,
11787 long symcount ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
11788 asymbol **syms ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
11793 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
11796 const char *relplt_name;
11797 bfd_boolean (*slurp_relocs) (bfd *, asection *, asymbol **, bfd_boolean);
11801 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
11807 if ((abfd->flags & (DYNAMIC | EXEC_P)) == 0)
11810 if (dynsymcount <= 0)
11813 if (!bed->plt_sym_val)
11816 relplt_name = bed->relplt_name;
11817 if (relplt_name == NULL)
11818 relplt_name = bed->rela_plts_and_copies_p ? ".rela.plt" : ".rel.plt";
11819 relplt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, relplt_name);
11820 if (relplt == NULL)
11823 hdr = &elf_section_data (relplt)->this_hdr;
11824 if (hdr->sh_link != elf_dynsymtab (abfd)
11825 || (hdr->sh_type != SHT_REL && hdr->sh_type != SHT_RELA))
11828 plt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".plt");
11832 slurp_relocs = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->slurp_reloc_table;
11833 if (! (*slurp_relocs) (abfd, relplt, dynsyms, TRUE))
11836 count = relplt->size / hdr->sh_entsize;
11837 size = count * sizeof (asymbol);
11838 p = relplt->relocation;
11839 for (i = 0; i < count; i++, p += bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel)
11841 size += strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name) + sizeof ("@plt");
11842 if (p->addend != 0)
11845 size += sizeof ("+0x") - 1 + 8 + 8 * (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS64);
11847 size += sizeof ("+0x") - 1 + 8;
11852 s = *ret = (asymbol *) bfd_malloc (size);
11856 names = (char *) (s + count);
11857 p = relplt->relocation;
11859 for (i = 0; i < count; i++, p += bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel)
11864 addr = bed->plt_sym_val (i, plt, p);
11865 if (addr == (bfd_vma) -1)
11868 *s = **p->sym_ptr_ptr;
11869 /* Undefined syms won't have BSF_LOCAL or BSF_GLOBAL set. Since
11870 we are defining a symbol, ensure one of them is set. */
11871 if ((s->flags & BSF_LOCAL) == 0)
11872 s->flags |= BSF_GLOBAL;
11873 s->flags |= BSF_SYNTHETIC;
11875 s->value = addr - plt->vma;
11878 len = strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name);
11879 memcpy (names, (*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name, len);
11881 if (p->addend != 0)
11885 memcpy (names, "+0x", sizeof ("+0x") - 1);
11886 names += sizeof ("+0x") - 1;
11887 bfd_sprintf_vma (abfd, buf, p->addend);
11888 for (a = buf; *a == '0'; ++a)
11891 memcpy (names, a, len);
11894 memcpy (names, "@plt", sizeof ("@plt"));
11895 names += sizeof ("@plt");
11902 /* It is only used by x86-64 so far.
11903 ??? This repeats *COM* id of zero. sec->id is supposed to be unique,
11904 but current usage would allow all of _bfd_std_section to be zero. */
11905 static const asymbol lcomm_sym
11906 = GLOBAL_SYM_INIT ("LARGE_COMMON", &_bfd_elf_large_com_section);
11907 asection _bfd_elf_large_com_section
11908 = BFD_FAKE_SECTION (_bfd_elf_large_com_section, &lcomm_sym,
11909 "LARGE_COMMON", 0, SEC_IS_COMMON);
11912 _bfd_elf_post_process_headers (bfd * abfd,
11913 struct bfd_link_info * link_info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
11915 Elf_Internal_Ehdr * i_ehdrp; /* ELF file header, internal form. */
11917 i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
11919 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_OSABI] = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_osabi;
11921 /* To make things simpler for the loader on Linux systems we set the
11922 osabi field to ELFOSABI_GNU if the binary contains symbols of
11923 the STT_GNU_IFUNC type or STB_GNU_UNIQUE binding. */
11924 if (i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_OSABI] == ELFOSABI_NONE
11925 && elf_tdata (abfd)->has_gnu_symbols)
11926 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_OSABI] = ELFOSABI_GNU;
11930 /* Return TRUE for ELF symbol types that represent functions.
11931 This is the default version of this function, which is sufficient for
11932 most targets. It returns true if TYPE is STT_FUNC or STT_GNU_IFUNC. */
11935 _bfd_elf_is_function_type (unsigned int type)
11937 return (type == STT_FUNC
11938 || type == STT_GNU_IFUNC);
11941 /* If the ELF symbol SYM might be a function in SEC, return the
11942 function size and set *CODE_OFF to the function's entry point,
11943 otherwise return zero. */
11946 _bfd_elf_maybe_function_sym (const asymbol *sym, asection *sec,
11949 bfd_size_type size;
11951 if ((sym->flags & (BSF_SECTION_SYM | BSF_FILE | BSF_OBJECT
11952 | BSF_THREAD_LOCAL | BSF_RELC | BSF_SRELC)) != 0
11953 || sym->section != sec)
11956 *code_off = sym->value;
11958 if (!(sym->flags & BSF_SYNTHETIC))
11959 size = ((elf_symbol_type *) sym)->internal_elf_sym.st_size;